(diff-unified->context): Use the new `apply' undo entry kind
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob2e8fca79156dfc7a6c0c0ba4dd1caa8d0a4965f5
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
25 #include <config.h>
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
31 #include <stdio.h>
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
134 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
135 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
137 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
138 #ifndef XtNpickTop
139 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
140 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
141 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
142 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
144 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
146 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
147 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
148 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #endif
151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
152 #include "widget.h"
153 #ifndef XtNinitialState
154 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
155 #endif
156 #endif
158 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
160 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
161 #ifdef USE_XIM
162 int use_xim = 1;
163 #else
164 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
165 #endif
169 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
171 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
173 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
174 start. */
176 static int any_help_event_p;
178 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
179 static Lisp_Object last_window;
181 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
183 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
185 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
187 int x_underline_at_descent_line;
189 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
190 use. */
192 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
194 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
195 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
196 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
197 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
199 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
201 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
202 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
203 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
204 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
206 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
208 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
210 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
212 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
213 /* The application context for Xt use. */
214 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
215 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
216 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
218 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
220 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
222 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
223 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
225 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
227 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
228 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
229 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
231 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
233 /* Mouse movement.
235 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
236 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
237 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
238 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
240 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
242 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
243 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
244 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
245 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
246 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
247 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
248 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
249 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
250 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
251 is off. */
253 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
255 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
256 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
257 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
259 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
261 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
262 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
263 an ordinary motion.
265 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
266 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
267 event. */
269 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
271 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
272 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
273 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
274 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
275 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
276 it's somewhat accurate. */
278 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
280 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
282 static Time last_user_time;
284 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
285 events. */
287 #ifdef __STDC__
288 static int volatile input_signal_count;
289 #else
290 static int input_signal_count;
291 #endif
293 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
295 static int x_noop_count;
297 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
299 extern char **initial_argv;
300 extern int initial_argc;
302 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
304 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
306 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
308 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
310 extern int errno;
312 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
314 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
316 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
318 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
319 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
320 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
322 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
323 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
325 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
326 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
328 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
329 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
330 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
331 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
333 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
334 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
335 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
336 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
337 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
338 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
339 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
340 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
341 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
342 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
343 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
344 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
345 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
346 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
347 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
348 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
349 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
350 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
351 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
352 enum text_cursor_kinds));
354 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
355 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
356 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
357 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
358 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
359 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
360 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
361 enum scroll_bar_part *,
362 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
363 unsigned long *));
364 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
365 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int));
366 static void x_sync_with_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
367 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
368 int *, struct input_event *));
369 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
370 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
371 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed P_ ((Display *, char *));
374 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
376 static void
377 x_flush (f)
378 struct frame *f;
380 BLOCK_INPUT;
381 if (f == NULL)
383 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
384 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
385 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
387 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
388 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
389 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
393 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
394 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
395 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
396 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
397 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
398 performance. */
400 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
403 /***********************************************************************
404 Debugging
405 ***********************************************************************/
407 #if 0
409 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
410 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
412 struct record
414 char *locus;
415 int type;
418 struct record event_record[100];
420 int event_record_index;
422 record_event (locus, type)
423 char *locus;
424 int type;
426 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
427 event_record_index = 0;
429 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
430 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
431 event_record_index++;
434 #endif /* 0 */
438 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
440 struct x_display_info *
441 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
442 Display *dpy;
444 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
446 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
447 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
448 return dpyinfo;
450 return 0;
455 /***********************************************************************
456 Starting and ending an update
457 ***********************************************************************/
459 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
460 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
461 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
462 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
463 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
465 static void
466 x_update_begin (f)
467 struct frame *f;
469 /* Nothing to do. */
473 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
474 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
475 position of W. */
477 static void
478 x_update_window_begin (w)
479 struct window *w;
481 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
482 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
484 updated_window = w;
485 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
487 BLOCK_INPUT;
489 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
491 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
492 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
494 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
495 highlighting. */
496 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
497 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
499 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
500 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
501 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
502 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
503 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
504 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
506 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
507 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
508 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
509 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
510 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
511 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
512 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
514 int i;
516 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
517 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
518 break;
520 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
521 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
523 #endif /* 0 */
526 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
530 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
532 static void
533 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
534 struct window *w;
535 int x, y0, y1;
537 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
538 struct face *face;
540 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
541 if (face)
542 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
543 face->foreground);
545 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
546 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
549 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
551 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
552 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
554 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
555 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
556 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
558 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
559 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
560 here. */
562 static void
563 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
564 struct window *w;
565 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
567 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
569 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
571 BLOCK_INPUT;
573 if (cursor_on_p)
574 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
575 output_cursor.vpos,
576 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
578 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
579 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
581 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
584 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
585 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
586 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
588 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
589 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
590 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
593 updated_window = NULL;
597 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
598 update_end. */
600 static void
601 x_update_end (f)
602 struct frame *f;
604 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
605 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
607 #ifndef XFlush
608 BLOCK_INPUT;
609 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
610 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
611 #endif
615 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
616 complete update has been performed. The global variable
617 updated_window is not available here. */
619 static void
620 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
621 struct frame *f;
623 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
625 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
627 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
628 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
630 BLOCK_INPUT;
631 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
632 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
633 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
634 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
635 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
636 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
642 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
643 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
644 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
645 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
646 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
647 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
649 static void
650 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
651 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
653 struct window *w = updated_window;
654 struct frame *f;
655 int width, height;
657 xassert (w);
659 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
660 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
662 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
663 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
664 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
665 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
666 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
667 overhead is very small. */
668 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
669 && desired_row->full_width_p
670 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
671 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
672 width != 0)
673 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
674 height > 0))
676 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
678 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
679 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
680 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
681 y -= width;
683 BLOCK_INPUT;
684 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
685 0, y, width, height, False);
686 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
687 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
688 y, width, height, False);
689 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
693 static void
694 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
695 struct window *w;
696 struct glyph_row *row;
697 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
699 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
700 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
701 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
702 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
703 struct face *face = p->face;
704 int rowY;
706 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
707 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
708 if (p->y < rowY)
710 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
711 visible last row. */
712 int oldY = row->y;
713 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
714 row->visible_height = p->h;
715 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
716 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
717 row->y = oldY;
718 row->visible_height = oldVH;
720 else
721 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
723 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
725 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
726 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
727 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
728 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
729 if (face->stipple)
730 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
731 else
732 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
734 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
735 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
737 if (!face->stipple)
738 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
741 if (p->which)
743 unsigned char *bits;
744 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
745 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
746 XGCValues gcv;
748 if (p->wd > 8)
749 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
750 else
751 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
753 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
754 by the server. */
755 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
756 (p->cursor_p
757 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
758 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
759 : face->foreground),
760 face->background, depth);
762 if (p->overlay_p)
764 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
765 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
766 bits, p->wd, p->h,
767 1, 0, 1);
768 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
769 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
770 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
771 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
774 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
775 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
776 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
778 if (p->overlay_p)
780 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
781 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
782 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
786 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
791 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
792 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
793 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
794 rarely happens). */
796 static void
797 XTset_terminal_modes ()
801 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
802 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
804 static void
805 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
811 /***********************************************************************
812 Display Iterator
813 ***********************************************************************/
815 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
817 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
820 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
821 is not contained in the font. */
823 static XCharStruct *
824 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
825 XFontStruct *font;
826 XChar2b *char2b;
827 int font_type; /* unused on X */
829 /* The result metric information. */
830 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
832 xassert (font && char2b);
834 if (font->per_char != NULL)
836 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
838 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
839 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
840 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
841 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
842 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
843 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
844 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
845 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
846 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
847 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
849 else
851 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
852 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
853 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
854 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
856 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
857 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
859 where:
861 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
862 / = integer division
863 \ = integer modulus */
864 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
865 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
866 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
867 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
869 pcm = (font->per_char
870 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
871 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
872 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
876 else
878 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
879 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
880 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
881 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
882 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
883 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
886 return ((pcm == NULL
887 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
888 ? NULL : pcm);
892 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
893 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
895 static int
896 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
897 int c;
898 XChar2b *char2b;
899 struct font_info *font_info;
900 int *two_byte_p;
902 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
903 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
905 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
906 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
907 fixed encoding. */
908 if (font_info->font_encoder)
910 /* It's a program. */
911 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
913 check_ccl_update (ccl);
914 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
916 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
917 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
918 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
920 else
922 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
923 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
924 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
927 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
929 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
930 program. */
931 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
932 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
933 else
934 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
936 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
938 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
939 encoding numbers. */
940 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
942 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
943 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
944 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
946 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
947 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
950 if (two_byte_p)
951 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
953 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
958 /***********************************************************************
959 Glyph display
960 ***********************************************************************/
964 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
965 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
967 int));
968 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
969 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
971 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
972 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
973 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
974 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
975 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
977 unsigned long *, double, int));
978 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
979 double, int, unsigned long));
980 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
981 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
982 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
983 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
984 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
985 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
986 int, int, int));
987 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
988 int, int, int, int, int, int,
989 XRectangle *));
990 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
991 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
993 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
994 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
995 #endif
998 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
999 face. */
1001 static void
1002 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
1003 struct glyph_string *s;
1005 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1006 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1007 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1008 && !s->cmp)
1009 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1010 else
1012 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1013 XGCValues xgcv;
1014 unsigned long mask;
1016 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1017 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1019 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1020 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1021 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1022 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1023 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1024 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1025 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1027 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1028 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1029 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1031 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1032 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1035 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1036 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1037 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1038 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1040 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1041 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1042 mask, &xgcv);
1043 else
1044 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1045 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1047 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1052 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1054 static void
1055 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1056 struct glyph_string *s;
1058 int face_id;
1059 struct face *face;
1061 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1062 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1063 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1064 if (face == NULL)
1065 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1067 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1068 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1069 else
1070 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1071 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1072 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1074 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1075 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1076 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1077 else
1079 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1080 but font FONT. */
1081 XGCValues xgcv;
1082 unsigned long mask;
1084 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1085 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1086 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1087 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1088 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1089 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1091 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1092 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1093 mask, &xgcv);
1094 else
1095 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1096 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1098 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1101 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1105 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1106 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1107 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1109 static INLINE void
1110 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1111 struct glyph_string *s;
1113 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1117 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1118 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1119 pattern. */
1121 static INLINE void
1122 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1123 struct glyph_string *s;
1125 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1127 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1129 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1130 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1132 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1134 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1135 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1137 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1139 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1140 s->stippled_p = 0;
1142 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1144 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1145 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1147 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1148 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1150 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1151 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1153 else
1155 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1156 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1159 /* GC must have been set. */
1160 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1164 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1165 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1167 static INLINE void
1168 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1169 struct glyph_string *s;
1171 XRectangle r;
1172 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1173 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1177 /* RIF:
1178 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1179 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1181 static void
1182 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1183 struct glyph_string *s;
1185 if (s->cmp == NULL
1186 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1188 XCharStruct cs;
1189 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1190 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1191 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1192 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1193 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1198 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1200 static INLINE void
1201 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1202 struct glyph_string *s;
1203 int x, y, w, h;
1205 XGCValues xgcv;
1206 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1207 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1208 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1209 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1213 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1214 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1215 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1216 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1217 contains the first component of a composition. */
1219 static void
1220 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1221 struct glyph_string *s;
1222 int force_p;
1224 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1225 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1226 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1228 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1230 if (s->stippled_p)
1232 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1233 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1234 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1235 s->y + box_line_width,
1236 s->background_width,
1237 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1238 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1239 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1241 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1242 || s->font_not_found_p
1243 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1244 || force_p)
1246 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1247 s->background_width,
1248 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1249 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1255 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1257 static void
1258 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1259 struct glyph_string *s;
1261 int i, x;
1263 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1264 of S to the right of that box line. */
1265 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1266 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1267 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1268 else
1269 x = s->x;
1271 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1272 loaded. */
1273 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1275 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1277 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1278 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1279 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1280 s->height - 1);
1281 x += g->pixel_width;
1284 else
1286 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1287 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1289 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1290 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1292 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1293 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1294 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1295 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1297 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1298 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1299 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1300 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1301 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1302 if (s->for_overlaps
1303 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1305 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1306 if (s->two_byte_p)
1307 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1308 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1309 else
1310 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1311 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1313 else
1315 if (s->two_byte_p)
1316 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1317 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1318 else
1319 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1320 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1323 if (s->face->overstrike)
1325 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1326 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1327 if (s->two_byte_p)
1328 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1329 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1330 else
1331 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1332 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1337 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1339 static void
1340 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1341 struct glyph_string *s;
1343 int i, x;
1345 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1346 of S to the right of that box line. */
1347 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1348 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1349 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1350 else
1351 x = s->x;
1353 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1354 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1355 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1356 this composition. */
1358 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1359 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1360 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1362 if (s->gidx == 0)
1363 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1364 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1366 else
1368 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1370 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1371 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1372 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1373 s->char2b + i, 1);
1374 if (s->face->overstrike)
1375 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1376 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1377 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1378 s->char2b + i, 1);
1384 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1386 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1387 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1388 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1389 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1390 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1393 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1394 cannot be determined. */
1396 static struct frame *
1397 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1398 Widget widget;
1400 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1401 Lisp_Object tail;
1402 struct frame *f;
1404 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1406 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1407 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1408 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1409 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1410 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1411 widget = XtParent (widget);
1413 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1414 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1415 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1416 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1417 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1418 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1419 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1420 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1421 return f;
1423 abort ();
1427 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1428 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1429 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1430 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1433 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1434 Widget widget;
1435 Colormap cmap;
1436 XColor *color;
1438 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1439 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1443 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1444 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1445 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1446 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1447 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1448 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1451 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1452 Widget widget;
1453 Display *display;
1454 Colormap cmap;
1455 unsigned long *pixel;
1456 double factor;
1457 int delta;
1459 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1460 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1464 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1465 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1467 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1469 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1470 sizeof (Screen *)},
1471 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1472 sizeof (Colormap)}
1476 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1477 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1479 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1482 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1484 DPY is the display we are working on.
1486 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1487 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1488 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1489 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1491 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1492 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1494 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1495 we allocated the color or not.
1497 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1499 static Boolean
1500 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1501 Display *dpy;
1502 XrmValue *args;
1503 Cardinal *nargs;
1504 XrmValue *from, *to;
1505 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1507 Screen *screen;
1508 Colormap cmap;
1509 Pixel pixel;
1510 String color_name;
1511 XColor color;
1513 if (*nargs != 2)
1515 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1516 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1517 "XtToolkitError",
1518 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1519 return False;
1522 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1523 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1524 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1526 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1528 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1529 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1531 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1533 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1534 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1536 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1537 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1539 pixel = color.pixel;
1540 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1542 else
1544 String params[1];
1545 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1547 params[0] = color_name;
1548 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1549 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1550 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1551 params, &nparams);
1552 return False;
1555 if (to->addr != NULL)
1557 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1559 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1560 return False;
1563 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1565 else
1567 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1568 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1571 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1572 return True;
1576 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1577 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1578 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1580 APP is the application context in which we work.
1582 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1583 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1584 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1586 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1588 static void
1589 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1590 XtAppContext app;
1591 XrmValuePtr to;
1592 XtPointer closure;
1593 XrmValuePtr args;
1594 Cardinal *nargs;
1596 if (*nargs != 2)
1598 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1599 "XtToolkitError",
1600 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1601 NULL, NULL);
1603 else if (closure != NULL)
1605 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1606 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1607 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1608 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1609 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1614 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1617 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1618 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1619 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1620 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1622 static const XColor *
1623 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1624 Display *dpy;
1625 int *ncells;
1627 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1629 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1631 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1632 int i;
1634 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1635 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1636 dpyinfo->color_cells
1637 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1638 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1640 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1643 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1644 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1647 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1648 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1652 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1653 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1655 void
1656 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1657 struct frame *f;
1658 XColor *colors;
1659 int ncolors;
1661 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1663 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1665 int i;
1666 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1668 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1669 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1670 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1671 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1674 else
1675 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1679 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1680 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1682 void
1683 x_query_color (f, color)
1684 struct frame *f;
1685 XColor *color;
1687 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1691 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1692 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1693 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1694 allocated. */
1696 static int
1697 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1698 Display *dpy;
1699 Colormap cmap;
1700 XColor *color;
1702 int rc;
1704 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1705 if (rc == 0)
1707 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1708 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1709 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1710 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1711 int nearest, i;
1712 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1713 int ncells;
1714 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1716 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1718 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1719 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1720 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1721 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1723 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1725 nearest = i;
1726 nearest_delta = delta;
1730 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1731 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1732 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1733 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1735 else
1737 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1738 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1739 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1740 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1741 XColor *cached_color;
1743 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1744 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1745 (cached_color->red != color->red
1746 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1747 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1749 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1750 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1751 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1755 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1756 if (rc)
1757 register_color (color->pixel);
1758 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1760 return rc;
1764 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1765 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1766 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1767 allocated. */
1770 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1771 struct frame *f;
1772 Colormap cmap;
1773 XColor *color;
1775 gamma_correct (f, color);
1776 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1780 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1781 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1782 get color reference counts right. */
1784 unsigned long
1785 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1786 struct frame *f;
1787 unsigned long pixel;
1789 XColor color;
1791 color.pixel = pixel;
1792 BLOCK_INPUT;
1793 x_query_color (f, &color);
1794 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1795 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1796 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1797 register_color (pixel);
1798 #endif
1799 return color.pixel;
1803 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1804 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1805 get color reference counts right. */
1807 unsigned long
1808 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1809 Display *dpy;
1810 Colormap cmap;
1811 unsigned long pixel;
1813 XColor color;
1815 color.pixel = pixel;
1816 BLOCK_INPUT;
1817 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1818 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1819 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1820 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1821 register_color (pixel);
1822 #endif
1823 return color.pixel;
1827 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1828 boosted.
1830 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1831 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1832 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1833 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1834 use an additional additive factor.
1836 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1837 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1838 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1841 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1842 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1843 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1844 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1845 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1846 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1848 static int
1849 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1850 struct frame *f;
1851 Display *display;
1852 Colormap cmap;
1853 unsigned long *pixel;
1854 double factor;
1855 int delta;
1857 XColor color, new;
1858 long bright;
1859 int success_p;
1861 /* Get RGB color values. */
1862 color.pixel = *pixel;
1863 x_query_color (f, &color);
1865 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1866 xassert (factor >= 0);
1867 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1868 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1869 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1871 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1872 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1874 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1875 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1876 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1877 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1878 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1880 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1881 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1882 /* The additive adjustment. */
1883 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1885 if (factor < 1)
1887 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1888 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1889 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1891 else
1893 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1894 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1895 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1899 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1900 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1901 if (success_p)
1903 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1905 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1906 delta to the RGB values. */
1907 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1909 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1910 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1911 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1912 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1914 else
1915 success_p = 1;
1916 *pixel = new.pixel;
1919 return success_p;
1923 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1924 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1925 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1926 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1927 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1928 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1930 static void
1931 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1932 struct frame *f;
1933 struct relief *relief;
1934 double factor;
1935 int delta;
1936 unsigned long default_pixel;
1938 XGCValues xgcv;
1939 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1940 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1941 unsigned long pixel;
1942 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1943 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1944 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1945 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1947 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1948 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1950 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1951 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1952 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1953 if (relief->gc
1954 && relief->allocated_p)
1956 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1957 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1960 /* Allocate new color. */
1961 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1962 pixel = background;
1963 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1964 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1966 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1967 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1970 if (relief->gc == 0)
1972 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1973 mask |= GCStipple;
1974 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1976 else
1977 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1981 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1983 static void
1984 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1985 struct glyph_string *s;
1987 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1988 unsigned long color;
1990 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1991 color = s->face->box_color;
1992 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1993 && s->img->pixmap
1994 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1995 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1996 else
1998 XGCValues xgcv;
2000 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2001 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2002 color = xgcv.background;
2005 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2006 || color != di->relief_background)
2008 di->relief_background = color;
2009 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2010 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2011 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2012 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2017 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2018 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2019 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2020 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2021 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2022 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2023 when drawing. */
2025 static void
2026 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2027 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2028 struct frame *f;
2029 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2030 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2031 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2033 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2034 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2035 int i;
2036 GC gc;
2038 if (raised_p)
2039 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2040 else
2041 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2042 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2044 /* Top. */
2045 if (top_p)
2046 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2047 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2048 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2049 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2051 /* Left. */
2052 if (left_p)
2053 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2054 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2055 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2057 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2058 if (raised_p)
2059 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2060 else
2061 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2062 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2064 /* Bottom. */
2065 if (bot_p)
2066 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2067 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2068 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2069 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2071 /* Right. */
2072 if (right_p)
2073 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2074 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2075 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2077 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2081 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2082 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2083 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2084 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2085 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2086 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2088 static void
2089 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2090 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2091 struct glyph_string *s;
2092 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2093 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2095 XGCValues xgcv;
2097 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2098 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2099 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2101 /* Top. */
2102 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2103 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2105 /* Left. */
2106 if (left_p)
2107 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2108 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2110 /* Bottom. */
2111 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2112 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2114 /* Right. */
2115 if (right_p)
2116 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2117 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2119 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2120 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2124 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2126 static void
2127 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2128 struct glyph_string *s;
2130 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2131 int left_p, right_p;
2132 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2133 XRectangle clip_rect;
2135 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2136 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2137 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2139 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2140 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2141 ? s->first_glyph
2142 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2144 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2145 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2146 left_x = s->x;
2147 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2148 ? last_x - 1
2149 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2150 top_y = s->y;
2151 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2153 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2154 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2155 && (s->prev == NULL
2156 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2157 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2158 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2159 && (s->next == NULL
2160 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2162 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2164 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2165 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2166 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2167 else
2169 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2170 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2171 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2176 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2178 static void
2179 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2180 struct glyph_string *s;
2182 int x = s->x;
2183 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2185 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2186 right of that line. */
2187 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2188 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2189 && s->slice.x == 0)
2190 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2192 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2193 by that margin. */
2194 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2195 x += s->img->hmargin;
2196 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2197 y += s->img->vmargin;
2199 if (s->img->pixmap)
2201 if (s->img->mask)
2203 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2204 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2205 trust on the shape extension to be available
2206 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2207 manually. */
2208 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2209 | GCFunction);
2210 XGCValues xgcv;
2211 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2213 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2214 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2215 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2216 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2217 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2219 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2220 image_rect.x = x;
2221 image_rect.y = y;
2222 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2223 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2224 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2225 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2226 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2227 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2229 else
2231 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2233 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2234 image_rect.x = x;
2235 image_rect.y = y;
2236 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2237 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2238 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2239 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2240 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2241 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2243 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2244 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2245 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2246 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2247 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2248 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2249 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2251 int r = s->img->relief;
2252 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2253 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2254 x - r, y - r,
2255 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2256 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2260 else
2261 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2262 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2263 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2267 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2269 static void
2270 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2271 struct glyph_string *s;
2273 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2274 XRectangle r;
2275 int x = s->x;
2276 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2278 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2279 right of that line. */
2280 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2281 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2282 && s->slice.x == 0)
2283 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2285 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2286 by that margin. */
2287 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2288 x += s->img->hmargin;
2289 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2290 y += s->img->vmargin;
2292 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2293 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2295 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2296 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2298 else
2300 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2301 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2304 x0 = x - thick;
2305 y0 = y - thick;
2306 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2307 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2309 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2310 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2311 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2312 s->slice.y == 0,
2313 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2314 s->slice.x == 0,
2315 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2316 &r);
2320 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2322 static void
2323 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2324 struct glyph_string *s;
2325 Pixmap pixmap;
2327 int x = 0;
2328 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2330 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2331 right of that line. */
2332 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2333 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2334 && s->slice.x == 0)
2335 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2337 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2338 by that margin. */
2339 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2340 x += s->img->hmargin;
2341 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2342 y += s->img->vmargin;
2344 if (s->img->pixmap)
2346 if (s->img->mask)
2348 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2349 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2350 trust on the shape extension to be available
2351 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2352 manually. */
2353 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2354 | GCFunction);
2355 XGCValues xgcv;
2357 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2358 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2359 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2360 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2361 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2363 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2364 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2365 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2366 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2368 else
2370 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2371 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2372 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2374 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2375 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2376 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2377 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2378 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2379 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2380 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2382 int r = s->img->relief;
2383 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2384 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2385 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2386 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2390 else
2391 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2392 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2393 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2397 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2398 give the rectangle to draw. */
2400 static void
2401 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2402 struct glyph_string *s;
2403 int x, y, w, h;
2405 if (s->stippled_p)
2407 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2408 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2409 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2410 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2412 else
2413 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2417 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2419 s->y
2420 s->x +-------------------------
2421 | s->face->box
2423 | +-------------------------
2424 | | s->img->margin
2426 | | +-------------------
2427 | | | the image
2431 static void
2432 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2433 struct glyph_string *s;
2435 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2436 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2437 int height;
2438 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2440 height = s->height;
2441 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2442 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2443 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2444 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2446 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2447 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2448 flickering. */
2449 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2450 if (height > s->slice.height
2451 || s->img->hmargin
2452 || s->img->vmargin
2453 || s->img->mask
2454 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2455 || s->width != s->background_width)
2457 if (s->img->mask)
2459 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2460 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2461 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2462 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2463 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2465 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2466 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2467 s->background_width,
2468 s->height, depth);
2470 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2471 pixmap. */
2472 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2474 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2475 if (s->stippled_p)
2477 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2478 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2479 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2480 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2481 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2483 else
2485 XGCValues xgcv;
2486 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2487 &xgcv);
2488 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2489 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2490 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2491 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2494 else
2496 int x = s->x;
2497 int y = s->y;
2499 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2500 && s->slice.x == 0)
2501 x += box_line_hwidth;
2503 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2504 y += box_line_vwidth;
2506 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2509 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2512 /* Draw the foreground. */
2513 if (pixmap != None)
2515 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2516 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2517 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2518 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2519 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2521 else
2522 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2524 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2525 if (s->img->relief
2526 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2527 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2528 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2532 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2534 static void
2535 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2536 struct glyph_string *s;
2538 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2539 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2541 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2542 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2544 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2545 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2546 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2547 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2549 if (x < left_x)
2551 background_width -= left_x - x;
2552 x = left_x;
2554 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2556 /* Draw cursor. */
2557 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2559 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2560 if (width < background_width)
2562 int y = s->y;
2563 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2564 XRectangle r;
2565 GC gc;
2567 x += width;
2568 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2569 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2571 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2572 gc = s->gc;
2574 else
2575 gc = s->face->gc;
2577 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2578 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2580 if (s->face->stipple)
2582 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2583 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2584 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2585 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2587 else
2589 XGCValues xgcv;
2590 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2591 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2592 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2593 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2597 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2599 int background_width = s->background_width;
2600 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2602 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2603 except for header line and mode line. */
2604 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2606 background_width -= left_x - x;
2607 x = left_x;
2609 if (background_width > 0)
2610 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2613 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2617 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2619 static void
2620 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2621 struct glyph_string *s;
2623 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2625 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2626 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2627 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2628 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2630 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2631 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2632 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2633 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2636 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2637 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2639 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2640 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2641 if (!s->for_overlaps
2642 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2643 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2644 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2647 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2648 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2649 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2650 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2651 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2653 else
2654 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2656 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2658 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2659 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2660 break;
2662 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2663 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2664 break;
2666 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2667 if (s->for_overlaps)
2668 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2669 else
2670 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2671 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2672 break;
2674 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2675 if (s->for_overlaps || s->gidx > 0)
2676 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2677 else
2678 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2679 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2680 break;
2682 default:
2683 abort ();
2686 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2688 /* Draw underline. */
2689 if (s->face->underline_p)
2691 unsigned long tem, h;
2692 int y;
2694 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2695 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2696 h = 1;
2698 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2699 if (!x_underline_at_descent_line)
2701 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2702 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2703 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2704 specs, and its default is
2706 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2707 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2709 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2710 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2711 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2712 else if (s->face->font)
2713 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2716 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2717 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2718 s->x, y, s->background_width, h);
2719 else
2721 XGCValues xgcv;
2722 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2723 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2724 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2725 s->x, y, s->background_width, h);
2726 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2730 /* Draw overline. */
2731 if (s->face->overline_p)
2733 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2735 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2736 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2737 s->background_width, h);
2738 else
2740 XGCValues xgcv;
2741 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2742 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2743 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2744 s->background_width, h);
2745 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2749 /* Draw strike-through. */
2750 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2752 unsigned long h = 1;
2753 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2755 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2756 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2757 s->width, h);
2758 else
2760 XGCValues xgcv;
2761 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2762 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2763 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2764 s->width, h);
2765 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2769 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2770 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2771 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2774 /* Reset clipping. */
2775 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2778 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2780 void
2781 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2782 struct frame *f;
2783 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2785 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2786 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2787 x, y, width, height,
2788 x + shift_by, y);
2791 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2792 for X frames. */
2794 static void
2795 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2796 register int n;
2798 abort ();
2802 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2803 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2805 void
2806 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2807 Display *dpy;
2808 Window window;
2809 int x, y;
2810 int width, height;
2811 int exposures;
2813 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2814 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2818 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2819 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2821 static void
2822 x_clear_frame ()
2824 struct frame *f;
2826 if (updating_frame)
2827 f = updating_frame;
2828 else
2829 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2831 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2832 longer visible. */
2833 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2834 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2835 output_cursor.x = -1;
2837 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2838 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2839 BLOCK_INPUT;
2840 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2842 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2843 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2844 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2846 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2848 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2853 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2855 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2856 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2858 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2861 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2862 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2864 static int
2865 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2866 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2868 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2869 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2870 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2872 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2873 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2874 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2877 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2879 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2880 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2881 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2884 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2885 positive. */
2886 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2887 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2889 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2890 negative. */
2891 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2894 void
2895 XTflash (f)
2896 struct frame *f;
2898 BLOCK_INPUT;
2901 GC gc;
2903 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2904 pixels into background pixels. */
2906 XGCValues values;
2908 values.function = GXxor;
2909 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2910 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2912 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2913 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2917 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2918 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2919 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2920 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2921 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2922 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2923 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2925 int width;
2927 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2928 edge it is next to. */
2929 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2931 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2932 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2933 break;
2935 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2936 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2937 break;
2939 default:
2940 break;
2943 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2945 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2946 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2948 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2949 flash_left,
2950 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2951 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2952 width, flash_height);
2953 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2954 flash_left,
2955 (height - flash_height
2956 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2957 width, flash_height);
2959 else
2960 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2961 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2962 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2963 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2965 x_flush (f);
2968 struct timeval wakeup;
2970 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2972 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2973 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2974 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2975 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2977 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2978 available. */
2979 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2981 struct timeval current;
2982 struct timeval timeout;
2984 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2986 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2987 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2988 break;
2990 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2991 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2992 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2994 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2995 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2999 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3000 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3002 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3003 flash_left,
3004 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3005 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
3006 width, flash_height);
3007 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3008 flash_left,
3009 (height - flash_height
3010 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3011 width, flash_height);
3013 else
3014 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3015 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3016 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3017 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3019 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3020 x_flush (f);
3024 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3027 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3030 /* Make audible bell. */
3032 void
3033 XTring_bell ()
3035 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3037 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3039 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3040 if (visible_bell)
3041 XTflash (f);
3042 else
3043 #endif
3045 BLOCK_INPUT;
3046 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3047 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3048 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3054 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3055 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3056 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3057 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3059 static void
3060 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3061 register int n;
3063 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3068 /***********************************************************************
3069 Line Dance
3070 ***********************************************************************/
3072 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3073 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3075 static void
3076 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3077 int vpos, n;
3079 abort ();
3083 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3085 static void
3086 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3087 struct window *w;
3088 struct run *run;
3090 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3091 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3093 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3094 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3095 fringe of W. */
3096 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3098 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3099 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3100 bottom_y = y + height;
3102 if (to_y < from_y)
3104 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3105 line at the bottom. */
3106 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3107 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3108 else
3109 height = run->height;
3111 else
3113 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3114 at the bottom. */
3115 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3116 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3117 else
3118 height = run->height;
3121 BLOCK_INPUT;
3123 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3124 updated_window = w;
3125 x_clear_cursor (w);
3127 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3128 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3129 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3130 x, from_y,
3131 width, height,
3132 x, to_y);
3134 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3139 /***********************************************************************
3140 Exposure Events
3141 ***********************************************************************/
3144 static void
3145 frame_highlight (f)
3146 struct frame *f;
3148 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3149 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3150 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3151 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3152 BLOCK_INPUT;
3153 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3154 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3155 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3156 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3159 static void
3160 frame_unhighlight (f)
3161 struct frame *f;
3163 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3164 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3165 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3166 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3167 BLOCK_INPUT;
3168 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3169 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3170 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3171 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3174 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3175 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3176 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3177 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3178 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3180 static void
3181 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3182 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3183 struct frame *frame;
3185 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3187 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3189 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3190 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3191 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3193 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3194 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3196 #if 0
3197 selected_frame = frame;
3198 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3199 selected_frame);
3200 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3201 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3202 #endif /* ! 0 */
3204 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3205 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3206 else
3207 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3210 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3213 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3214 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3215 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3217 static void
3218 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3219 int type;
3220 int state;
3221 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3222 struct frame *frame;
3223 struct input_event *bufp;
3225 if (type == FocusIn)
3227 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3229 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3230 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3232 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3233 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3234 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3235 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3236 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3238 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3239 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3243 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3245 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3246 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3247 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3248 #endif
3250 else if (type == FocusOut)
3252 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3254 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3256 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3257 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3260 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3261 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3262 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3263 #endif
3267 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3268 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3270 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3272 static void
3273 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3274 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3275 XEvent *event;
3276 struct input_event *bufp;
3278 struct frame *frame;
3280 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3281 if (! frame)
3282 return;
3284 switch (event->type)
3286 case EnterNotify:
3287 case LeaveNotify:
3289 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3290 int focus_state
3291 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3293 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3294 && event->xcrossing.focus
3295 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3296 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3297 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3298 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3300 break;
3302 case FocusIn:
3303 case FocusOut:
3304 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3305 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3306 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3307 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3308 break;
3313 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3315 void
3316 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3317 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3319 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3322 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3323 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3324 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3326 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3327 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3328 the appropriate X display info. */
3330 static void
3331 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3332 struct frame *frame;
3334 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3337 static void
3338 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3339 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3341 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3343 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3345 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3346 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3347 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3348 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3349 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3351 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3352 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3355 else
3356 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3358 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3360 if (old_highlight)
3361 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3362 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3363 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3369 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3371 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3372 static void
3373 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3374 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3376 int min_code, max_code;
3377 KeySym *syms;
3378 int syms_per_code;
3379 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3381 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3382 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3383 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3384 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3385 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3387 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3388 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3389 #else
3390 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3391 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3392 #endif
3394 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3395 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3396 &syms_per_code);
3397 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3399 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3400 Alt keysyms are on. */
3402 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3403 int found_alt_or_meta;
3405 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3407 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3408 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3410 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3412 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3413 if (code == 0)
3414 continue;
3416 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3418 int code_col;
3420 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3422 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3424 switch (sym)
3426 case XK_Meta_L:
3427 case XK_Meta_R:
3428 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3429 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3430 break;
3432 case XK_Alt_L:
3433 case XK_Alt_R:
3434 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3435 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3436 break;
3438 case XK_Hyper_L:
3439 case XK_Hyper_R:
3440 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3441 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3442 code_col = syms_per_code;
3443 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3444 break;
3446 case XK_Super_L:
3447 case XK_Super_R:
3448 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3449 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3450 code_col = syms_per_code;
3451 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3452 break;
3454 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3455 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3456 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3457 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3458 code_col = syms_per_code;
3459 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3460 break;
3468 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3469 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3471 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3472 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3475 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3476 make them just meta, not alt. */
3477 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3479 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3482 XFree ((char *) syms);
3483 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3486 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3487 Emacs uses. */
3489 unsigned int
3490 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3491 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3492 unsigned int state;
3494 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3495 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3496 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3497 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3498 Lisp_Object tem;
3500 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3501 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3502 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3503 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3504 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3505 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3506 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3507 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3510 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3511 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3512 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3513 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3514 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3515 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3518 static unsigned int
3519 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3520 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3521 unsigned int state;
3523 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3524 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3525 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3526 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3528 Lisp_Object tem;
3530 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3531 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3532 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3533 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3534 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3535 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3536 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3537 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3540 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3541 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3542 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3543 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3544 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3545 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3548 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3550 char *
3551 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3552 KeySym keysym;
3554 char *value;
3556 BLOCK_INPUT;
3557 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3558 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3560 return value;
3565 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3567 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3569 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3570 the mouse. */
3572 static Lisp_Object
3573 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3574 struct input_event *result;
3575 XButtonEvent *event;
3576 struct frame *f;
3578 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3579 otherwise. */
3580 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3581 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3582 result->timestamp = event->time;
3583 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3584 event->state)
3585 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3586 ? up_modifier
3587 : down_modifier));
3589 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3590 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3591 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3592 result->arg = Qnil;
3593 return Qnil;
3597 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3598 The input handler calls this.
3600 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3601 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3602 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3603 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3605 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3606 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3608 static int
3609 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3610 FRAME_PTR frame;
3611 XMotionEvent *event;
3613 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3614 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3615 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3617 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3618 return 0;
3620 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3622 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3623 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3624 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3625 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3626 return 1;
3630 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3631 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3632 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3633 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3634 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3635 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3637 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3638 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3639 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3640 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3641 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3642 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3643 return 1;
3646 return 0;
3650 /************************************************************************
3651 Mouse Face
3652 ************************************************************************/
3654 static void
3655 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3657 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3658 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3659 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3660 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3661 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3666 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3667 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3669 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3670 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3671 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3672 position on the scroll bar.
3674 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3675 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3676 the mouse is over.
3678 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3679 was at this position.
3681 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3683 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3684 movement. */
3686 static void
3687 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3688 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3689 int insist;
3690 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3691 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3692 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3693 unsigned long *time;
3695 FRAME_PTR f1;
3697 BLOCK_INPUT;
3699 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3700 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3701 else
3703 Window root;
3704 int root_x, root_y;
3706 Window dummy_window;
3707 int dummy;
3709 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3711 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3712 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3713 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3714 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3716 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3718 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3719 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3720 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3722 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3723 &root,
3725 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3726 a different screen. */
3727 &dummy_window,
3729 /* The position on that root window. */
3730 &root_x, &root_y,
3732 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3733 &dummy, &dummy,
3735 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3736 we don't care. */
3737 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3739 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3740 containing the pointer. */
3742 Window win, child;
3743 int win_x, win_y;
3744 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3746 win = root;
3748 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3749 structure is changing at the same time this function
3750 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3752 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3754 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3755 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3757 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3758 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3759 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3761 /* From-window, to-window. */
3762 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3764 /* From-position, to-position. */
3765 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3767 /* Child of win. */
3768 &child);
3769 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3771 else
3773 while (1)
3775 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3777 /* From-window, to-window. */
3778 root, win,
3780 /* From-position, to-position. */
3781 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3783 /* Child of win. */
3784 &child);
3786 if (child == None || child == win)
3787 break;
3789 win = child;
3790 parent_x = win_x;
3791 parent_y = win_y;
3794 /* Now we know that:
3795 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3796 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3797 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3798 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3799 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3800 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3801 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3802 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3803 never use them in that case.) */
3805 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3806 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3808 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3809 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3810 on the frame. */
3811 if (f1 != NULL
3812 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3813 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3814 f1 = NULL;
3815 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3818 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3819 f1 = 0;
3821 x_uncatch_errors ();
3823 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3824 if (! f1)
3826 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3828 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3830 if (bar)
3832 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3833 win_x = parent_x;
3834 win_y = parent_y;
3838 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3839 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3841 if (f1)
3843 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3844 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3845 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3846 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3847 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3848 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3849 the frame are divided into. */
3851 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3852 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3854 *bar_window = Qnil;
3855 *part = 0;
3856 *fp = f1;
3857 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3858 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3859 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3864 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3869 /***********************************************************************
3870 Scroll bars
3871 ***********************************************************************/
3873 /* Scroll bar support. */
3875 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3876 manages it.
3877 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3878 bits. */
3880 static struct scroll_bar *
3881 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3882 Display *display;
3883 Window window_id;
3885 Lisp_Object tail;
3887 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3888 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3889 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3891 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3892 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3893 tail = XCDR (tail))
3895 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3897 frame = XCAR (tail);
3898 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3899 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3900 abort ();
3902 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3903 right window ID. */
3904 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3905 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3906 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3907 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3908 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3909 condemned = Qnil,
3910 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3911 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3912 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3913 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3914 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3917 return 0;
3921 #if defined USE_LUCID
3923 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3924 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3926 static Widget
3927 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3928 Window window;
3930 Lisp_Object tail;
3932 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3933 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3934 tail = XCDR (tail))
3936 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3937 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3939 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3940 return menu_bar;
3943 return NULL;
3946 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3949 /************************************************************************
3950 Toolkit scroll bars
3951 ************************************************************************/
3953 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3955 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3956 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3957 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3958 struct scroll_bar *));
3959 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3960 int, int, int));
3963 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3964 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3966 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3968 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3970 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3972 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3973 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3975 #ifndef USE_GTK
3976 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3978 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3980 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3982 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3983 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3984 to avoid jerkyness. */
3986 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3988 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3989 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3990 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3991 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3993 static void
3994 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3995 num_params)
3996 Widget widget;
3997 XtPointer client_data;
3998 String action_name;
3999 XEvent *event;
4000 String *params;
4001 Cardinal *num_params;
4003 int scroll_bar_p;
4004 char *end_action;
4006 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4007 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4008 end_action = "Release";
4009 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4010 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4011 end_action = "EndScroll";
4012 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4014 if (scroll_bar_p
4015 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4016 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4018 struct window *w;
4020 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4021 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4022 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4024 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4026 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4027 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4028 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4030 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4031 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4033 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4034 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4037 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4039 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4040 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4042 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4043 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4046 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4047 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4048 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4049 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4051 static void
4052 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4053 Lisp_Object window;
4054 int part, portion, whole;
4056 XEvent event;
4057 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4058 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4059 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4060 int i;
4062 BLOCK_INPUT;
4064 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4065 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4066 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4067 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4068 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4069 ev->format = 32;
4071 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4072 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4073 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4074 into that array in the event. */
4075 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4076 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4077 break;
4079 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4081 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4082 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4083 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4085 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4086 nbytes);
4087 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4088 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4091 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4092 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4093 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4094 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4095 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4096 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4098 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4099 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4100 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4101 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4102 #endif
4104 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4105 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4106 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4107 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4108 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4112 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4113 in *IEVENT. */
4115 static void
4116 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4117 XEvent *event;
4118 struct input_event *ievent;
4120 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4121 Lisp_Object window;
4122 struct frame *f;
4123 struct window *w;
4125 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4126 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4128 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4129 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4131 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4132 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4133 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4134 #ifdef USE_GTK
4135 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4136 #else
4137 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4138 #endif
4139 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4140 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4141 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4142 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4143 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4147 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4149 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4151 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4154 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4155 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4156 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4158 static void
4159 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4160 Widget widget;
4161 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4163 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4164 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4165 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4167 switch (cs->reason)
4169 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4170 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4171 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4172 break;
4174 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4175 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4176 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4177 break;
4179 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4180 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4181 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4182 break;
4184 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4185 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4186 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4187 break;
4189 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4190 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4191 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4192 break;
4194 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4195 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4196 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4197 break;
4199 case XmCR_DRAG:
4201 int slider_size;
4203 /* Get the slider size. */
4204 BLOCK_INPUT;
4205 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4206 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4208 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4209 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4210 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4211 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4213 break;
4215 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4216 break;
4219 if (part >= 0)
4221 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4222 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4223 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4228 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4229 #ifdef USE_GTK
4230 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4231 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4233 static void
4234 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4235 GtkRange *widget;
4236 gpointer data;
4238 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4239 gdouble previous;
4240 gdouble position;
4241 gdouble *p;
4242 int diff;
4244 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4245 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4247 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4249 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4250 if (! p)
4252 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4253 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4254 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4257 previous = *p;
4258 *p = position;
4260 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4262 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4264 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4266 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4267 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4269 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4271 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4272 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4274 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4276 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4277 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4279 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4281 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4282 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4284 else
4286 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4287 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4288 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4289 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4292 if (part >= 0)
4294 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4295 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4296 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4300 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4302 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4303 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4304 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4305 the thumb is. */
4307 static void
4308 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4309 Widget widget;
4310 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4312 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4313 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4314 float shown;
4315 int whole, portion, height;
4316 int part;
4318 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4319 BLOCK_INPUT;
4320 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4321 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4323 whole = 10000000;
4324 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4326 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4327 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4328 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4329 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4330 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4331 bottom). */
4332 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4333 else
4334 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4336 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4337 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4338 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4339 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4343 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4344 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4345 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4346 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4347 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4348 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4349 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4351 static void
4352 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4353 Widget widget;
4354 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4356 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4357 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4358 int position = (long) call_data;
4359 Dimension height;
4360 int part;
4362 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4363 BLOCK_INPUT;
4364 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4365 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4367 if (abs (position) >= height)
4368 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4370 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4371 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4372 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4373 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4374 else
4375 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4377 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4378 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4379 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4380 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4383 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4384 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4386 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4388 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4389 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4391 #ifdef USE_GTK
4392 static void
4393 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4394 struct frame *f;
4395 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4397 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4399 BLOCK_INPUT;
4400 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4401 scroll_bar_name);
4402 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4405 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4407 static void
4408 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4409 struct frame *f;
4410 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4412 Window xwindow;
4413 Widget widget;
4414 Arg av[20];
4415 int ac = 0;
4416 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4417 unsigned long pixel;
4419 BLOCK_INPUT;
4421 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4422 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4423 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4424 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4425 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4426 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4427 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4428 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4429 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4431 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4432 if (pixel != -1)
4434 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4435 ++ac;
4438 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4439 if (pixel != -1)
4441 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4442 ++ac;
4445 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4446 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4448 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4449 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4450 (XtPointer) bar);
4451 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4452 (XtPointer) bar);
4453 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4454 (XtPointer) bar);
4455 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4456 (XtPointer) bar);
4457 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4458 (XtPointer) bar);
4459 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4460 (XtPointer) bar);
4461 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4462 (XtPointer) bar);
4464 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4465 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4467 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4468 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4469 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4470 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4472 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4474 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4475 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4476 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4477 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4478 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4479 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4480 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4481 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4483 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4484 if (pixel != -1)
4486 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4487 ++ac;
4490 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4491 if (pixel != -1)
4493 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4494 ++ac;
4497 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4499 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4500 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4502 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4503 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4504 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4505 pixel = -1;
4506 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4508 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4510 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4511 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4512 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4513 pixel = -1;
4514 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4517 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4518 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4519 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4520 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4521 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4522 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4524 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4525 ++ac;
4527 else
4528 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4529 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4530 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4532 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4533 the shadows. */
4534 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4535 ++ac;
4537 /* Specify the colors. */
4538 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4539 if (pixel != -1)
4541 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4542 ++ac;
4544 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4545 if (pixel != -1)
4547 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4548 ++ac;
4551 #endif
4553 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4554 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4557 char *initial = "";
4558 char *val = initial;
4559 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4560 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4561 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4562 #endif
4563 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4564 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4565 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4566 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4567 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4568 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4572 /* Define callbacks. */
4573 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4574 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4575 (XtPointer) bar);
4577 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4578 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4580 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4582 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4583 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4584 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4585 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4587 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4588 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4589 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4590 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4592 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4594 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4597 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4598 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4600 #ifdef USE_GTK
4601 static void
4602 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4603 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4604 int portion, position, whole;
4606 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4609 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4610 static void
4611 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4612 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4613 int portion, position, whole;
4615 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4616 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4617 float top, shown;
4619 BLOCK_INPUT;
4621 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4623 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4624 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4625 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4626 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4627 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4628 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4629 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4630 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4631 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4632 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4633 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4634 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4635 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4636 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4637 whole += portion;
4639 if (whole <= 0)
4640 top = 0, shown = 1;
4641 else
4643 top = (float) position / whole;
4644 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4647 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4649 int size, value;
4651 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4652 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4653 value. */
4654 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4655 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4656 size = max (size, 1);
4658 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4659 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4660 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4662 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4664 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4666 if (whole == 0)
4667 top = 0, shown = 1;
4668 else
4670 top = (float) position / whole;
4671 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4675 float old_top, old_shown;
4676 Dimension height;
4677 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4678 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4679 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4680 XtNheight, &height,
4681 NULL);
4683 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4684 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4685 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4686 else
4687 top = old_top;
4688 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4689 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4691 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4692 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4693 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4694 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4696 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4697 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4698 else
4700 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4701 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4702 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4704 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4708 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4710 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4712 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4714 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4718 /************************************************************************
4719 Scroll bars, general
4720 ************************************************************************/
4722 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4723 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4724 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4725 scroll bar. */
4727 static struct scroll_bar *
4728 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4729 struct window *w;
4730 int top, left, width, height;
4732 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4733 struct scroll_bar *bar
4734 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4736 BLOCK_INPUT;
4738 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4739 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4740 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4742 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4743 unsigned long mask;
4744 Window window;
4746 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4747 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4748 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4750 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4751 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4752 | ExposureMask);
4753 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4755 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4757 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4758 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4759 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4760 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4761 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4762 left, top, width,
4763 window_box_height (w), False);
4765 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4766 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4767 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4768 top,
4769 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4770 height,
4771 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4773 CopyFromParent,
4774 CopyFromParent,
4775 CopyFromParent,
4776 /* Attributes. */
4777 mask, &a);
4778 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4780 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4782 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4783 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4784 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4785 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4786 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4787 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4788 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4789 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4791 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4792 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4793 bar->prev = Qnil;
4794 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4795 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4796 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4798 /* Map the window/widget. */
4799 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4801 #ifdef USE_GTK
4802 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4803 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4804 top,
4805 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4806 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4807 max (height, 1));
4808 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4809 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4810 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4811 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4812 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4813 top,
4814 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4815 max (height, 1), 0);
4816 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4817 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4819 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4820 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4821 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4823 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4824 return bar;
4828 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4830 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4831 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4832 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4833 events.)
4835 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4836 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4837 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4838 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4839 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4841 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4843 static void
4844 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4845 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4846 int start, end;
4847 int rebuild;
4849 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4850 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4851 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4852 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4854 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4855 if (! rebuild
4856 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4857 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4858 return;
4860 BLOCK_INPUT;
4863 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4864 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4865 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4867 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4868 the distance between start and end. */
4870 int length = end - start;
4872 if (start < 0)
4873 start = 0;
4874 else if (start > top_range)
4875 start = top_range;
4876 end = start + length;
4878 if (end < start)
4879 end = start;
4880 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4881 end = top_range;
4884 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4885 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4886 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4888 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4889 if (end > top_range)
4890 end = top_range;
4892 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4893 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4894 that many pixels tall. */
4895 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4897 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4898 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4899 if (0 < start)
4900 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4901 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4902 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4903 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4904 inside_width, start,
4905 False);
4907 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4908 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4909 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4910 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4912 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4913 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4914 /* x, y, width, height */
4915 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4916 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4917 inside_width, end - start);
4919 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4920 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4921 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4922 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4924 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4925 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4926 if (end < inside_height)
4927 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4928 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4929 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4930 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4931 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4932 False);
4936 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4939 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4941 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4942 nil. */
4944 static void
4945 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4946 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4948 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4949 BLOCK_INPUT;
4951 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4952 #ifdef USE_GTK
4953 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4954 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4955 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4956 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4957 #else
4958 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4959 #endif
4961 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4962 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4964 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4968 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4969 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4970 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4971 create one. */
4973 static void
4974 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4975 struct window *w;
4976 int portion, whole, position;
4978 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4979 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4980 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4981 int window_y, window_height;
4983 /* Get window dimensions. */
4984 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4985 top = window_y;
4986 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4987 height = window_height;
4989 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4990 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4992 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4993 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4994 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4995 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4996 else
4997 sb_width = width;
4999 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5000 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5001 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5002 sb_left = (left +
5003 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5004 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
5005 : 0));
5006 else
5007 sb_left = (left +
5008 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5009 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
5010 : width - sb_width));
5011 #else
5012 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5013 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5014 else
5015 sb_left = left;
5016 #endif
5018 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5019 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5021 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5023 BLOCK_INPUT;
5024 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5025 left, top, width, height, False);
5026 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5029 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5031 else
5033 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5034 unsigned int mask = 0;
5036 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5038 BLOCK_INPUT;
5040 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5041 mask |= CWX;
5042 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5043 mask |= CWY;
5044 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5045 mask |= CWWidth;
5046 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5047 mask |= CWHeight;
5049 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5051 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5052 if (mask)
5054 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5055 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5056 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5057 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5058 left, top, width, height, False);
5059 #ifdef USE_GTK
5060 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5061 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5062 top,
5063 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5064 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5065 max (height, 1));
5066 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5067 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5068 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5069 top,
5070 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5071 max (height, 1), 0);
5072 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5074 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5076 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5077 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5078 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5080 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5081 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5082 height, False);
5083 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5084 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5085 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5086 height, False);
5089 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5090 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5091 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5092 example. */
5094 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5095 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5096 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5098 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5099 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5100 left + area_width - rest, top,
5101 rest, height, False);
5102 else
5103 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5104 left, top, rest, height, False);
5108 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5109 if (mask)
5111 XWindowChanges wc;
5113 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5114 wc.y = top;
5115 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5116 wc.height = height;
5117 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5118 mask, &wc);
5121 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5123 /* Remember new settings. */
5124 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5125 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5126 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5127 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5129 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5132 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5133 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5134 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5135 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5136 dragged. */
5137 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5139 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5141 if (whole == 0)
5142 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5143 else
5145 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5146 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5147 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5150 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5152 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5156 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5157 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5158 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5159 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5160 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5161 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5162 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5164 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5165 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5166 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5168 static void
5169 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5170 FRAME_PTR frame;
5172 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5173 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5175 Lisp_Object bar;
5176 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5177 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5178 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5179 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5180 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5181 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5182 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5187 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5188 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5190 static void
5191 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5192 struct window *window;
5194 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5195 struct frame *f;
5197 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5198 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5199 abort ();
5201 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5203 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5204 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5205 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5207 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5208 the lists. */
5209 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5210 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5211 return;
5212 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5213 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5214 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5215 else
5216 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5217 one or the other! */
5218 abort ();
5220 else
5221 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5223 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5224 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5226 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5227 bar->prev = Qnil;
5228 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5229 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5230 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5233 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5234 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5236 static void
5237 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5238 FRAME_PTR f;
5240 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5242 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5244 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5245 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5246 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5248 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5250 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5252 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5254 next = b->next;
5255 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5258 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5259 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5263 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5264 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5265 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5267 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5268 mark bits. */
5270 static void
5271 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5272 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5273 XEvent *event;
5275 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5276 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5277 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5278 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5280 BLOCK_INPUT;
5282 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5284 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5285 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5286 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5287 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5289 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5290 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5292 /* x, y, width, height */
5293 0, 0,
5294 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5295 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5297 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5298 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5299 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5300 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
5302 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5305 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5307 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5308 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5310 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5311 mark bits. */
5314 static void
5315 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5316 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5317 XEvent *event;
5318 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5320 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5321 abort ();
5323 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5324 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5325 emacs_event->modifiers
5326 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5327 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5328 event->xbutton.state)
5329 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5330 ? up_modifier
5331 : down_modifier));
5332 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5333 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5334 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5336 #if 0
5337 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5338 int internal_height
5339 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5340 #endif
5341 int top_range
5342 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5343 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5345 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5346 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5348 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5349 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5350 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5351 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5352 else
5353 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5355 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5356 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5357 whether or not we're dragging. */
5358 #if 0
5359 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5360 holding it. */
5361 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5362 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5363 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5364 #endif
5366 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5367 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5368 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5369 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5371 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5372 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5374 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5375 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5377 #endif
5379 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5380 #if 0
5381 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5382 the handle. */
5383 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5384 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5385 else
5386 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5387 #else
5388 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5389 #endif
5391 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5395 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5397 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5399 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5400 mark bits. */
5402 static void
5403 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5404 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5405 XEvent *event;
5407 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5409 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5411 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5412 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5414 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5415 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5417 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5418 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5420 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5422 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5424 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5429 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5431 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5432 on the scroll bar. */
5434 static void
5435 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5436 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5437 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5438 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5439 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5440 unsigned long *time;
5442 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5443 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5444 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5445 int win_x, win_y;
5446 Window dummy_window;
5447 int dummy_coord;
5448 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5450 BLOCK_INPUT;
5452 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5453 report that. */
5454 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5456 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5457 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5458 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5460 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5461 &win_x, &win_y,
5463 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5464 &dummy_mask))
5466 else
5468 #if 0
5469 int inside_height
5470 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5471 #endif
5472 int top_range
5473 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5475 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5477 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5478 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5480 if (win_y < 0)
5481 win_y = 0;
5482 if (win_y > top_range)
5483 win_y = top_range;
5485 *fp = f;
5486 *bar_window = bar->window;
5488 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5489 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5490 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5491 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5492 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5493 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5494 else
5495 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5497 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5498 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5500 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5501 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5504 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5506 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5510 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5511 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5512 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5513 redraw them. */
5515 void
5516 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5517 FRAME_PTR f;
5519 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5520 Lisp_Object bar;
5522 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5523 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5524 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5525 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5526 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5527 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5528 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5529 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5530 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5531 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5535 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5537 #if 0
5538 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5539 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5540 sometimes don't work. */
5542 static Time enter_timestamp;
5543 #endif
5545 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5546 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5547 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5548 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5550 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5551 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5553 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5555 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5556 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5558 static int temp_index;
5559 static short temp_buffer[100];
5561 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5562 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5563 temp_index = 0; \
5564 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5566 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5567 on a particular display. */
5569 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5571 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5572 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5573 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5574 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5576 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5578 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5579 do \
5581 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5582 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5583 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5584 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5585 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5586 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5588 while (0)
5590 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5591 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5594 enum
5596 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5597 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5598 X_EVENT_DROP
5601 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5602 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5603 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5605 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5606 this event further.
5607 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5609 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5610 static int
5611 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5612 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5613 XEvent *event;
5615 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5616 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5617 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5618 was created. */
5620 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5621 event->xclient.window);
5623 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5625 #endif
5627 #ifdef USE_GTK
5628 static int current_count;
5629 static int current_finish;
5630 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5632 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5633 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5634 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5635 static GdkFilterReturn
5636 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5637 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5638 GdkEvent *ev;
5639 gpointer data;
5641 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5643 if (current_count >= 0)
5645 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5647 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5649 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5650 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5651 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5652 so we do it here. */
5653 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5654 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5655 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5656 #endif
5658 if (! dpyinfo)
5659 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5660 else
5662 current_count +=
5663 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5664 current_hold_quit);
5667 else
5668 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5670 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5671 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5673 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5675 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5678 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5680 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5681 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5682 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5684 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5686 static int
5687 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5688 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5689 XEvent *eventp;
5690 int *finish;
5691 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5693 union {
5694 struct input_event ie;
5695 struct selection_input_event sie;
5696 } inev;
5697 int count = 0;
5698 int do_help = 0;
5699 int nbytes = 0;
5700 struct frame *f;
5701 struct coding_system coding;
5702 XEvent event = *eventp;
5704 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5706 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5707 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5708 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5710 switch (event.type)
5712 case ClientMessage:
5714 if (event.xclient.message_type
5715 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5716 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5718 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5719 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5721 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5722 could be the shell widget window
5723 if the frame has no title bar. */
5724 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5725 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5726 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5727 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5728 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5729 #endif
5730 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5731 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5732 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5733 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5734 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5735 needed.
5737 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5738 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5739 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5740 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5741 Emacs. */
5743 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5744 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5745 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5746 if (f)
5748 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5749 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5750 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5751 x_catch_errors (d);
5752 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5753 /* The ICCCM says this is
5754 the only valid choice. */
5755 RevertToParent,
5756 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5757 /* This is needed to detect the error
5758 if there is an error. */
5759 XSync (d, False);
5760 x_uncatch_errors ();
5762 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5763 #endif /* 0 */
5764 goto done;
5767 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5768 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5770 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5771 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5772 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5773 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5774 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5775 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5776 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5777 session manager and one for this. */
5778 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5779 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5780 #endif
5782 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5783 event.xclient.window);
5784 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5785 for a single Emacs process. */
5786 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5787 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5788 event.xclient.window,
5789 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5790 else if (f)
5791 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5792 event.xclient.window,
5793 0, 0);
5795 goto done;
5798 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5799 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5801 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5802 event.xclient.window);
5803 if (!f)
5804 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5806 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5807 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5808 goto done;
5811 goto done;
5814 if (event.xclient.message_type
5815 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5817 goto done;
5820 if (event.xclient.message_type
5821 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5823 int new_x, new_y;
5824 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5826 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5827 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5829 if (f)
5831 f->left_pos = new_x;
5832 f->top_pos = new_y;
5834 goto done;
5837 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5838 if (event.xclient.message_type
5839 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5841 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5842 if (f)
5843 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5844 &event, NULL);
5845 goto done;
5847 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5849 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5850 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5851 || (event.xclient.message_type
5852 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5854 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5855 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5856 currently never do because we are interested in
5857 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5858 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5859 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5860 if (!f)
5861 goto OTHER;
5862 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5863 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5864 goto done;
5867 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5868 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5869 we construct an input_event. */
5870 if (event.xclient.message_type
5871 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5873 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5874 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5875 goto done;
5877 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5879 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5880 if (!f)
5881 goto OTHER;
5882 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5883 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5885 break;
5887 case SelectionNotify:
5888 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
5889 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5890 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5891 goto OTHER;
5892 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5893 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5894 break;
5896 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5897 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
5898 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5899 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5900 goto OTHER;
5901 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5903 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5905 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5906 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5907 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5908 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5909 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5911 break;
5913 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5914 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
5915 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5916 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5917 goto OTHER;
5918 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5920 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5921 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5923 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5924 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5925 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
5926 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5927 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
5928 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
5929 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5930 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5932 break;
5934 case PropertyNotify:
5935 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
5936 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5937 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5938 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5939 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5940 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5941 goto OTHER;
5942 #endif
5943 #endif
5944 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5945 goto OTHER;
5947 case ReparentNotify:
5948 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5949 if (f)
5951 int x, y;
5952 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5953 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5954 f->left_pos = x;
5955 f->top_pos = y;
5957 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5958 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5959 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
5961 goto OTHER;
5963 case Expose:
5964 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5965 if (f)
5967 x_check_fullscreen (f);
5969 #ifdef USE_GTK
5970 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
5971 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
5972 event.xexpose.window,
5973 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5974 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
5975 FALSE);
5976 #endif
5977 if (f->async_visible == 0)
5979 f->async_visible = 1;
5980 f->async_iconified = 0;
5981 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
5982 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
5984 else
5985 expose_frame (f,
5986 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5987 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
5989 else
5991 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5992 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5993 #endif
5994 #if defined USE_LUCID
5995 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
5996 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
5997 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
5999 Widget widget
6000 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6001 if (widget)
6002 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6004 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6006 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6007 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6008 goto OTHER;
6009 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6010 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6011 event.xexpose.window);
6013 if (bar)
6014 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6015 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6016 else
6017 goto OTHER;
6018 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6019 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6021 break;
6023 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6024 source area was obscured or not
6025 available. */
6026 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6027 if (f)
6029 expose_frame (f,
6030 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6031 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6032 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6034 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6035 else
6036 goto OTHER;
6037 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6038 break;
6040 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6041 source area was completely
6042 available. */
6043 break;
6045 case UnmapNotify:
6046 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6047 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6049 tip_window = 0;
6050 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6053 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6054 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6055 the frame was deleted. */
6057 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6058 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6059 display that won't ever be seen. */
6060 f->async_visible = 0;
6061 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6062 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6063 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6064 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6065 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6066 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6067 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6069 f->async_iconified = 1;
6071 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6072 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6075 goto OTHER;
6077 case MapNotify:
6078 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6079 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6080 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6081 goto OTHER;
6083 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6084 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6085 frame is visible. */
6086 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6087 if (f)
6089 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6090 the frame's display structures.
6091 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6092 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6093 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6094 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6095 if (! f->async_iconified)
6096 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6098 f->async_visible = 1;
6099 f->async_iconified = 0;
6100 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6102 if (f->iconified)
6104 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6105 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6107 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6108 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6109 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6110 to update the frame titles
6111 in case this is the second frame. */
6112 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6114 goto OTHER;
6116 case KeyPress:
6118 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6119 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6121 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6122 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6123 if (popup_activated ())
6124 goto OTHER;
6125 #endif
6127 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6129 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6130 mouse highlighting. */
6131 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6132 && (f == 0
6133 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6135 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6136 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6139 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6140 if (f == 0)
6142 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6143 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6144 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6145 event.xkey.window);
6146 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6148 widget = XtParent (widget);
6149 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6152 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6154 if (f != 0)
6156 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6157 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6158 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6159 his Emacs hang.
6161 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6162 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6163 status_return even if the input is too long to
6164 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6165 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6166 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6167 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6168 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6169 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6170 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6171 int modifiers;
6172 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6173 Lisp_Object c;
6175 #ifdef USE_GTK
6176 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6177 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6178 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6179 (see above). */
6180 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6181 #endif
6183 event.xkey.state
6184 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6185 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6186 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6188 /* This will have to go some day... */
6190 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6191 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6192 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6193 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6194 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6195 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6196 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6198 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6199 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6200 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6201 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6202 not it is combined with Meta. */
6203 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6204 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6206 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6207 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6209 Status status_return;
6211 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6212 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6213 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6214 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6215 &status_return);
6216 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6218 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6219 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6220 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6221 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6222 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6223 &status_return);
6225 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6226 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6227 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6228 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6229 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6230 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6231 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6232 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6233 &status_return);
6234 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6236 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6237 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6238 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6239 &event.xkey,
6240 copy_bufptr,
6241 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6242 &status_return);
6245 #endif
6247 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6248 break;
6249 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6251 keysym = NoSymbol;
6252 modifiers = 0;
6254 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6255 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6256 abort ();
6258 else
6259 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6260 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6261 &compose_status);
6262 #else
6263 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6264 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6265 &compose_status);
6266 #endif
6268 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6269 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6270 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6271 break;
6273 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6274 orig_keysym = keysym;
6276 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6277 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6278 inev.ie.modifiers
6279 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6280 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6282 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6283 translations to characters. */
6284 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6285 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6287 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6288 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6289 goto done_keysym;
6292 /* Keysyms directly mapped to supported Unicode characters. */
6293 if ((keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x010033ff)
6294 || (keysym >= 0x0100e000 && keysym <= 0x0100ffff))
6296 int code = keysym & 0xFFFF, charset_id, c1, c2;
6298 if (code < 0x80)
6300 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6301 inev.ie.code = code;
6303 else if (code < 0x100)
6305 if (code < 0xA0)
6306 charset_id = CHARSET_8_BIT_CONTROL;
6307 else
6308 charset_id = charset_latin_iso8859_1;
6309 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6310 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, code, 0);
6312 else
6314 if (code < 0x2500)
6315 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_0100_24ff,
6316 code -= 0x100;
6317 else if (code < 0xE000)
6318 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_2500_33ff,
6319 code -= 0x2500;
6320 else
6321 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_e000_ffff,
6322 code -= 0xE000;
6323 c1 = (code / 96) + 32, c2 = (code % 96) + 32;
6324 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6325 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, c1, c2);
6327 goto done_keysym;
6330 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6331 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6332 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6333 Vx_keysym_table,
6334 Qnil))))
6336 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6337 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6338 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6339 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6340 goto done_keysym;
6343 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6344 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6345 || keysym == XK_Delete
6346 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6347 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6348 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6349 #endif
6350 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6351 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6352 #ifdef HPUX
6353 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6354 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6355 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6356 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6357 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6358 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6359 #endif
6360 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6361 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6362 #endif
6363 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6364 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6365 #endif
6366 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6367 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6368 #endif
6369 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6370 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6371 #endif
6372 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6373 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6374 #endif
6375 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6376 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6377 #endif
6378 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6379 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6380 #endif
6381 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6382 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6383 #endif
6384 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6385 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6386 #endif
6387 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6388 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6389 #endif
6390 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6391 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6392 #endif
6393 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6394 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6395 #endif
6396 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6397 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6398 #endif
6399 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6400 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6401 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6402 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6403 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6404 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6405 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6406 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6407 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6408 #endif
6409 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6410 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6411 #endif
6412 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6413 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6414 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6415 don't have real modifiers but
6416 should be treated similarly to
6417 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6418 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6419 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6420 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6421 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6422 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6423 #endif
6426 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6427 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6428 key. */
6429 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6430 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6431 goto done_keysym;
6434 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6435 register int i;
6436 register int c;
6437 int nchars, len;
6439 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6440 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6441 we used just above and the locale. */
6442 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6443 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6444 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6445 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6446 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6447 gives us composition information. */
6448 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6450 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6452 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6456 /* Decode the input data. */
6457 int require;
6458 unsigned char *p;
6460 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6461 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6462 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6463 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6464 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6465 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6466 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6467 nbytes = coding.produced;
6468 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6469 copy_bufptr = p;
6472 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6473 character events. */
6474 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6476 if (nchars == nbytes)
6477 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6478 else
6479 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6480 nbytes - i, len);
6481 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6482 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6483 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6484 inev.ie.code = c;
6485 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6488 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6489 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6490 count += nbytes;
6492 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6494 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6495 break;
6498 done_keysym:
6499 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6500 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6501 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6502 client. */
6503 break;
6504 #else
6505 goto OTHER;
6506 #endif
6508 case KeyRelease:
6509 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6510 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6511 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6512 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6513 client. */
6514 break;
6515 #else
6516 goto OTHER;
6517 #endif
6519 case EnterNotify:
6520 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6521 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6523 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6525 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6526 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6528 #if 0
6529 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6531 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6532 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6533 || !(f->auto_lower)
6534 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6536 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6537 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6540 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6541 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6542 #endif
6544 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6545 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6546 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6547 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6548 #ifdef USE_GTK
6549 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6550 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6551 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6552 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6553 #endif
6554 goto OTHER;
6556 case FocusIn:
6557 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6558 goto OTHER;
6560 case LeaveNotify:
6561 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6562 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6564 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6565 if (f)
6567 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6569 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6570 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6571 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6572 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6575 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6576 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6577 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6578 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6579 if (any_help_event_p)
6580 do_help = -1;
6582 #ifdef USE_GTK
6583 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6584 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6585 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6586 #endif
6587 goto OTHER;
6589 case FocusOut:
6590 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6591 goto OTHER;
6593 case MotionNotify:
6595 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6596 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6597 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6599 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6600 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6601 f = last_mouse_frame;
6602 else
6603 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6605 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6607 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6608 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6611 if (f)
6614 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6615 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window))
6617 Lisp_Object window;
6619 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6620 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6621 0, 0, 0, 0);
6623 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6624 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6625 will be selected iff it is active. */
6626 if (WINDOWP (window)
6627 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6628 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6630 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6631 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6634 last_window=window;
6636 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6637 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6639 else
6641 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6642 struct scroll_bar *bar
6643 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6644 event.xmotion.window);
6646 if (bar)
6647 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6648 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6650 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6651 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6652 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6655 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6656 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6657 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6658 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6659 do_help = 1;
6660 goto OTHER;
6663 case ConfigureNotify:
6664 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6665 if (f)
6667 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6668 #ifdef USE_GTK
6669 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6670 event.xconfigure.height);
6671 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6672 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6673 do this one, the right one will come later.
6674 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6675 need to reset it below. */
6676 int dont_resize
6677 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6678 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6679 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6680 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6682 if (dont_resize)
6683 goto OTHER;
6685 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6686 is called by the code that handles resizing
6687 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6689 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6690 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6691 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6692 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6693 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6694 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6695 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6697 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6698 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6699 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6701 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6702 #endif
6704 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6705 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6707 #ifdef USE_GTK
6708 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6709 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6710 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6711 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6712 #endif
6714 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6716 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6717 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6720 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6721 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6722 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6723 #endif
6725 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6727 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6728 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6729 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6730 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6733 goto OTHER;
6735 case ButtonRelease:
6736 case ButtonPress:
6738 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6739 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6740 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6742 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6743 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6744 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6746 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6747 && last_mouse_frame
6748 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6749 f = last_mouse_frame;
6750 else
6751 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6753 if (f)
6755 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6756 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6757 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6759 Lisp_Object window;
6760 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6761 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6763 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6764 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6766 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6768 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6769 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6770 else
6771 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6772 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6773 event.xbutton.state));
6777 if (!tool_bar_p)
6778 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6779 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6781 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6782 if (! popup_activated ())
6783 #endif
6785 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6787 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6788 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6790 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6791 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6793 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6794 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6796 else
6797 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6801 else
6803 struct scroll_bar *bar
6804 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6805 event.xbutton.window);
6807 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6808 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6809 scroll bars. */
6810 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6812 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6813 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6815 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6816 if (bar)
6817 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6818 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6821 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6823 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6824 last_mouse_frame = f;
6826 if (!tool_bar_p)
6827 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6829 else
6830 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6832 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6833 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6834 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6835 if (f != 0)
6836 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6838 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6839 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6840 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6841 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6842 Instead, save it away
6843 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6844 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6845 if (
6846 #ifdef USE_GTK
6847 ! popup_activated ()
6849 #endif
6850 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6851 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6852 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6853 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6854 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6855 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6856 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6857 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6859 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6860 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6861 #ifdef USE_GTK
6862 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6863 #endif
6865 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6867 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6868 goto OTHER;
6871 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6872 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6873 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6875 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6877 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6878 if (f->output_data.x)
6879 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6881 else
6882 goto OTHER;
6884 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6885 else
6886 goto OTHER;
6887 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6889 break;
6891 case CirculateNotify:
6892 goto OTHER;
6894 case CirculateRequest:
6895 goto OTHER;
6897 case VisibilityNotify:
6898 goto OTHER;
6900 case MappingNotify:
6901 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6902 local cache. */
6903 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6905 case MappingModifier:
6906 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6907 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6908 case MappingKeyboard:
6909 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6911 goto OTHER;
6913 default:
6914 OTHER:
6915 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6916 BLOCK_INPUT;
6917 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6918 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6919 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6920 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6921 break;
6924 done:
6925 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6927 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6928 count++;
6931 if (do_help
6932 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6934 Lisp_Object frame;
6936 if (f)
6937 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6938 else
6939 frame = Qnil;
6941 if (do_help > 0)
6943 any_help_event_p = 1;
6944 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6945 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6947 else
6949 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6950 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6952 count++;
6955 *eventp = event;
6956 return count;
6960 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6961 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6962 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6964 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6966 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6967 XEvent *event;
6968 Display *display;
6970 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6971 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6973 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6975 if (dpyinfo)
6976 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6978 return finish;
6982 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6983 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6984 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6986 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6987 thus pretending to be `read'.
6989 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6991 static int
6992 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6993 register int sd;
6994 int expected;
6995 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6997 int count = 0;
6998 XEvent event;
6999 int event_found = 0;
7000 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7002 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7004 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7005 return -1;
7008 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7009 BLOCK_INPUT;
7011 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7012 input_signal_count++;
7014 ++handling_signal;
7016 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
7017 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
7018 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
7020 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
7021 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
7022 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
7023 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
7024 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
7025 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
7026 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
7027 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
7028 #endif
7030 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
7031 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
7032 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7033 for X connections. */
7034 #ifndef SIGIO
7035 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7036 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7038 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7039 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7040 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7041 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7043 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7044 #endif /* SIGIO */
7045 #endif
7047 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7048 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7050 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7051 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7054 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7056 struct input_event inev;
7057 BLOCK_INPUT;
7058 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7059 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7060 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7062 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7063 count++;
7065 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7067 #endif
7069 #ifndef USE_GTK
7070 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7072 int finish;
7074 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7076 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7077 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7078 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7079 break;
7080 #endif
7081 event_found = 1;
7083 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7085 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7086 goto out;
7088 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7091 #ifdef USE_GTK
7093 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7094 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7095 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7096 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7098 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7099 from all displays. */
7101 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7103 current_count = count;
7104 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7106 gtk_main_iteration ();
7108 count = current_count;
7109 current_count = -1;
7110 current_hold_quit = 0;
7112 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7113 break;
7115 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7117 out:;
7119 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7120 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7121 if (! event_found)
7123 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7124 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7125 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7126 x_noop_count++;
7127 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7129 x_noop_count=0;
7131 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7132 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7134 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7136 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7137 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7141 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7142 raise it now. */
7143 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7144 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7146 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7147 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7150 --handling_signal;
7151 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7153 return count;
7159 /***********************************************************************
7160 Text Cursor
7161 ***********************************************************************/
7163 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7164 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7166 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7167 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7168 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7170 static void
7171 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7172 struct window *w;
7173 struct glyph_row *row;
7174 int area;
7175 GC gc;
7177 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7178 XRectangle clip_rect;
7179 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7181 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7183 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7184 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7185 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7186 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7187 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7189 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7193 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7195 static void
7196 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7197 struct window *w;
7198 struct glyph_row *row;
7200 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7201 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7202 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7203 int x, y, wd, h;
7204 XGCValues xgcv;
7205 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7206 GC gc;
7208 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7209 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7210 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7211 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7212 return;
7214 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7215 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7216 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7218 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7219 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7220 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7221 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7222 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7223 else
7224 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7225 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7226 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7228 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7229 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7230 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7231 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7235 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7237 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7238 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7239 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7240 --gerd. */
7242 static void
7243 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7244 struct window *w;
7245 struct glyph_row *row;
7246 int width;
7247 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7249 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7250 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7252 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7253 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7254 and mini-buffer. */
7255 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7256 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7257 return;
7259 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7260 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7261 the bar might not be in the window. */
7262 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7264 struct glyph_row *row;
7265 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7266 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7268 else
7270 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7271 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7272 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7273 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7274 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7275 XGCValues xgcv;
7277 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7278 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7279 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7280 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7281 that the glyph is legible. */
7282 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7283 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7284 else
7285 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7286 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7288 if (gc)
7289 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7290 else
7292 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7293 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7296 if (width < 0)
7297 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7298 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7300 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7301 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7303 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7304 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7305 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7306 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7307 width, row->height);
7308 else
7309 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7310 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7311 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7312 row->height - width),
7313 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7314 width);
7316 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7321 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7323 static void
7324 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7325 struct frame *f;
7326 Cursor cursor;
7328 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7332 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7334 static void
7335 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7336 struct frame *f;
7337 int x, y, width, height;
7339 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7340 x, y, width, height, False);
7344 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7346 static void
7347 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7348 struct window *w;
7349 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7350 int x, y;
7351 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7352 int on_p, active_p;
7354 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7356 if (on_p)
7358 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7359 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7361 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7362 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7364 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7365 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7367 else
7368 switch (cursor_type)
7370 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7371 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7372 break;
7374 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7375 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7376 break;
7378 case BAR_CURSOR:
7379 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7380 break;
7382 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7383 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7384 break;
7386 case NO_CURSOR:
7387 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7388 break;
7390 default:
7391 abort ();
7394 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7395 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7396 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7397 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7398 #endif
7401 #ifndef XFlush
7402 if (updating_frame != f)
7403 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7404 #endif
7408 /* Icons. */
7410 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7413 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7414 struct frame *f;
7415 Lisp_Object file;
7417 int bitmap_id;
7419 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7420 return 1;
7422 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7423 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7424 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7425 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7427 if (STRINGP (file))
7429 #ifdef USE_GTK
7430 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7431 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7432 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7433 return 0;
7434 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7435 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7436 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7438 else
7440 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7441 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7443 int rc = -1;
7445 #if defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7446 #ifdef USE_GTK
7447 if (xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7448 return 0;
7449 #else
7450 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7451 if (rc != -1)
7452 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7453 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7454 #endif /* defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS) */
7456 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7457 if (rc == -1)
7459 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7460 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7461 if (rc == -1)
7462 return 1;
7464 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7465 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7469 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7470 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7471 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7472 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7473 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7475 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7478 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7479 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7481 return 0;
7485 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7486 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7489 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7490 struct frame *f;
7491 char *icon_name;
7493 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7494 return 1;
7496 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7498 XTextProperty text;
7499 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7500 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7501 text.format = 8;
7502 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7503 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7505 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7506 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7507 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7509 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7510 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7511 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7512 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7514 return 0;
7517 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7519 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7520 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7522 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7523 be called from a signal handler.
7526 struct x_error_message_stack {
7527 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7528 Display *dpy;
7529 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7531 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7533 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7534 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7535 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7537 static void
7538 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7539 Display *display;
7540 XErrorEvent *error;
7542 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7543 x_error_message->string,
7544 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7547 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7548 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7549 operating on.
7551 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7552 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7553 stored in *x_error_message.
7555 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7556 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7558 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7560 void x_check_errors ();
7562 void
7563 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7564 Display *dpy;
7566 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7568 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7569 XSync (dpy, False);
7571 data->dpy = dpy;
7572 data->string[0] = 0;
7573 data->prev = x_error_message;
7574 x_error_message = data;
7577 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7578 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7580 void
7581 x_uncatch_errors ()
7583 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7585 BLOCK_INPUT;
7587 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7588 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7589 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7590 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7592 tmp = x_error_message;
7593 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7594 xfree (tmp);
7595 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7598 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7599 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7600 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7602 void
7603 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7604 Display *dpy;
7605 char *format;
7607 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7608 XSync (dpy, False);
7610 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7612 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7613 bcopy (x_error_message->string, string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7614 x_uncatch_errors ();
7615 error (format, string);
7619 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7620 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7623 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7624 Display *dpy;
7626 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7627 XSync (dpy, False);
7629 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7632 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7634 void
7635 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7636 Display *dpy;
7638 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7641 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7643 void
7644 x_fully_uncatch_errors ()
7646 while (x_error_message)
7647 x_uncatch_errors ();
7650 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7653 x_catching_errors ()
7655 return x_error_message != 0;
7658 #if 0
7659 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7660 x_trace_wire ()
7662 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7664 #endif /* ! 0 */
7667 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7668 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7669 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7670 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7671 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7673 static SIGTYPE
7674 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7675 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7677 #ifdef USG
7678 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7679 must reestablish each time */
7680 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7681 #endif /* USG */
7685 /************************************************************************
7686 Handling X errors
7687 ************************************************************************/
7689 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7691 static char *error_msg;
7693 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7694 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7695 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7697 static void
7698 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7700 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7701 exit (70);
7704 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7705 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7707 static SIGTYPE
7708 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7709 Display *dpy;
7710 char *error_message;
7712 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7713 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7715 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7716 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7717 handling_signal = 0;
7719 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7720 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7721 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7722 the original message here. */
7723 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7725 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7726 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7727 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7729 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7730 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7731 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7733 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7734 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7736 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7737 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7738 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7740 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7741 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7742 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7743 if (dpyinfo)
7745 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7746 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7747 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7748 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7750 #endif
7752 #ifdef USE_GTK
7753 if (dpyinfo)
7754 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7755 #endif
7757 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7758 if (dpyinfo)
7759 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7761 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7762 that are on the dead display. */
7763 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7765 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7766 minibuf_frame
7767 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7768 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7769 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7770 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7771 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7772 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7775 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7776 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7777 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7778 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7779 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7780 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7782 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7783 trying to find a replacement. */
7784 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7785 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7788 if (dpyinfo)
7789 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7791 x_uncatch_errors ();
7793 if (x_display_list == 0)
7795 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7796 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7797 exit (70);
7800 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7801 #ifdef SIGIO
7802 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7803 #endif
7804 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7805 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7807 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7808 error ("%s", error_msg);
7811 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7812 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7813 static void x_error_quitter P_ ((Display *, XErrorEvent *));
7815 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7816 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7818 static int
7819 x_error_handler (display, error)
7820 Display *display;
7821 XErrorEvent *error;
7823 if (x_error_message)
7824 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7825 else
7826 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7827 return 0;
7830 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7831 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7832 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7834 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7836 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7837 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7838 #else
7839 #define NO_INLINE
7840 #endif
7842 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7844 #ifdef noinline
7845 #undef noinline
7846 #endif
7848 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7849 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7851 static void NO_INLINE
7852 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7853 Display *display;
7854 XErrorEvent *error;
7856 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7858 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7859 or colors that are not defined. */
7861 if (error->error_code == BadName)
7862 return;
7864 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7865 original error handler. */
7867 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7868 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7869 buf, error->request_code);
7870 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7874 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7875 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7876 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7878 static int
7879 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7880 Display *display;
7882 char buf[256];
7884 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7885 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7886 return 0;
7889 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7891 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7892 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7893 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7894 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7896 Lisp_Object
7897 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7898 struct frame *f;
7899 register char *fontname;
7901 struct font_info *fontp
7902 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7904 if (!fontp)
7905 return Qnil;
7907 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7908 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7909 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7911 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
7912 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
7913 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7915 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7917 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7918 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7920 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7921 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7922 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7924 else
7926 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7927 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7930 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7931 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7933 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7934 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7935 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7936 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7937 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7938 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7940 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7941 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7942 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7943 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7944 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7947 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7950 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7951 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7952 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7953 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7955 Lisp_Object
7956 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7957 struct frame *f;
7958 char *fontsetname;
7960 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7961 Lisp_Object result;
7963 if (fontset < 0)
7964 return Qnil;
7966 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7967 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7968 to do. */
7969 return fontset_name (fontset);
7971 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7973 if (!STRINGP (result))
7974 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7975 return Qnil;
7977 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7978 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7980 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7981 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7982 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7983 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7984 #endif
7986 return build_string (fontsetname);
7990 /***********************************************************************
7991 X Input Methods
7992 ***********************************************************************/
7994 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7996 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7998 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7999 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8000 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8002 static void
8003 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
8004 XIM xim;
8005 XPointer client_data;
8006 XPointer call_data;
8008 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8009 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8011 BLOCK_INPUT;
8013 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8014 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8016 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8017 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8019 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8020 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8024 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8025 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8026 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8027 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8030 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8032 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8033 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8034 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
8035 #endif
8037 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8038 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8040 static void
8041 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8042 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8043 char *resource_name;
8045 XIM xim;
8047 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8048 if (use_xim)
8050 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8051 EMACS_CLASS);
8052 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8054 if (xim)
8056 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8057 XIMCallback destroy;
8058 #endif
8060 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8061 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8063 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8064 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8065 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8066 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8067 #endif
8071 else
8072 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8073 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8077 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8079 struct xim_inst_t
8081 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8082 char *resource_name;
8085 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8086 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8087 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8088 when the callback was registered. */
8090 static void
8091 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8092 Display *display;
8093 XPointer client_data;
8094 XPointer call_data;
8096 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8097 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8099 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8100 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8101 return;
8103 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8105 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8106 as they have no XIC. */
8107 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8109 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8111 BLOCK_INPUT;
8112 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8114 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8116 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8117 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8119 create_frame_xic (f);
8120 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8121 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8122 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8124 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8125 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8130 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8134 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8137 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8138 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8139 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8140 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8142 static void
8143 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8144 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8145 char *resource_name;
8147 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8148 if (use_xim)
8150 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8151 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8152 int len;
8154 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8155 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8156 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8157 len = strlen (resource_name);
8158 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8159 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8160 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8161 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8162 xim_instantiate_callback,
8163 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8164 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8165 least, hence the configure test. */
8166 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8167 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8168 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8169 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8170 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8173 else
8174 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8175 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8179 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8181 static void
8182 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8183 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8185 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8186 if (use_xim)
8188 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8189 if (dpyinfo->display)
8190 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8191 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8192 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8193 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8194 if (dpyinfo->display)
8195 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8196 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8197 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8199 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8202 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8206 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8207 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8209 void
8210 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8211 struct frame *f;
8213 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8215 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8216 is already for the top-left corner. */
8217 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8218 return;
8220 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8221 position that fits on the screen. */
8222 if (flags & XNegative)
8223 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8224 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8227 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8229 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8230 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8231 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8233 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8234 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8235 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8236 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8237 is right, though.
8239 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8240 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8242 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8243 #endif
8245 if (flags & YNegative)
8246 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8249 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8250 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8251 so the flags should correspond. */
8252 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8255 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8256 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8257 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8258 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8259 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8261 void
8262 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8263 struct frame *f;
8264 register int xoff, yoff;
8265 int change_gravity;
8267 int modified_top, modified_left;
8269 if (change_gravity != 0)
8271 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8272 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8274 f->top_pos = yoff;
8275 f->left_pos = xoff;
8276 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8277 if (xoff < 0)
8278 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8279 if (yoff < 0)
8280 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8281 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8283 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8285 BLOCK_INPUT;
8286 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8288 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8289 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8291 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8293 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8294 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8295 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8296 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8297 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8300 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8301 modified_left, modified_top);
8303 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8304 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8305 ? 1 : 0);
8307 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8308 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8309 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8310 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8311 of the frame.
8313 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8314 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8315 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8317 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8318 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8319 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8320 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8321 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8322 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8324 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8327 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8328 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8329 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8330 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8331 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Standards_2fwm_2dspec. */
8333 static int
8334 wm_supports (f, atomname)
8335 struct frame *f;
8336 const char *atomname;
8338 Atom actual_type;
8339 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8340 int i, rc, actual_format;
8341 Atom prop_atom;
8342 Window wmcheck_window;
8343 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8344 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8345 long max_len = 65536;
8346 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8347 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8348 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8349 Atom want_atom;
8351 BLOCK_INPUT;
8353 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", False);
8355 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8356 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8357 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8358 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8359 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8361 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8363 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8364 x_uncatch_errors ();
8365 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8366 return 0;
8369 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8370 XFree (tmp_data);
8372 /* Check if window exists. */
8373 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8374 x_sync (f);
8375 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8377 x_uncatch_errors ();
8378 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8379 return 0;
8382 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8384 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8385 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8386 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8387 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8388 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8389 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8391 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8392 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTED", False);
8393 tmp_data = NULL;
8394 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8395 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8396 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8397 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8399 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8401 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8402 x_uncatch_errors ();
8403 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8404 return 0;
8407 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8408 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8409 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8412 rc = 0;
8413 want_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, atomname, False);
8415 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8416 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8418 x_uncatch_errors ();
8419 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8421 return rc;
8424 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8426 static int
8427 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f)
8428 struct frame *f;
8430 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE");
8432 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8433 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8434 if (!have_net_atom)
8435 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN");
8437 if (have_net_atom)
8439 Lisp_Object frame;
8440 const char *atom = "_NET_WM_STATE";
8441 const char *fs = "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN";
8442 const char *fw = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ";
8443 const char *fh = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT";
8444 const char *what = NULL;
8446 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8448 /* If there are _NET_ atoms we assume we have extended window manager
8449 hints. */
8450 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8452 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8453 what = fs;
8454 break;
8455 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8456 what = fw;
8457 break;
8458 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8459 what = fh;
8460 break;
8463 if (what != NULL && !wm_supports (f, what)) return 0;
8466 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8467 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8468 make_number (32),
8469 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8470 Fcons
8471 (make_unibyte_string (fs,
8472 strlen (fs)),
8473 Qnil)));
8474 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8475 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8476 make_number (32),
8477 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8478 Fcons
8479 (make_unibyte_string (fh,
8480 strlen (fh)),
8481 Qnil)));
8482 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8483 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8484 make_number (32),
8485 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8486 Fcons
8487 (make_unibyte_string (fw,
8488 strlen (fw)),
8489 Qnil)));
8490 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8491 if (what != NULL)
8492 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8493 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8494 make_number (32),
8495 Fcons (make_number (1), /* Add */
8496 Fcons
8497 (make_unibyte_string (what,
8498 strlen (what)),
8499 Qnil)));
8502 return have_net_atom;
8505 static void
8506 XTfullscreen_hook (f)
8507 FRAME_PTR f;
8509 if (f->async_visible)
8511 BLOCK_INPUT;
8512 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f);
8513 x_sync (f);
8514 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8519 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8520 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8521 static void
8522 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8523 struct frame *f;
8525 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8527 int width, height, ign;
8529 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8530 return;
8532 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8534 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8536 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8537 when setting WM manager hints.
8538 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8539 x_check_expected_move. */
8540 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8542 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8543 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8544 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8546 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8547 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8552 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8553 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8554 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8555 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8556 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8557 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8558 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8560 static void
8561 x_check_expected_move (f, expected_left, expected_top)
8562 struct frame *f;
8563 int expected_left;
8564 int expected_top;
8566 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8568 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8569 window manager window around the frame. */
8571 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8573 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8575 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8577 int adjusted_left;
8578 int adjusted_top;
8580 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8581 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8582 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8584 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8586 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8587 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8589 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8590 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8592 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8594 else
8595 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8596 frame's position. */
8598 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8602 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8603 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8604 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8605 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8606 of an exact comparison. */
8608 static void
8609 x_sync_with_move (f, left, top, fuzzy)
8610 struct frame *f;
8611 int left, top, fuzzy;
8613 int count = 0;
8615 while (count++ < 50)
8617 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8619 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8620 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8621 loop. */
8623 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8624 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8626 if (fuzzy)
8628 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8629 pixels. */
8631 if (abs (current_left - left) <= 10 && abs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8632 return;
8634 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8635 return;
8638 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8639 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8641 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8645 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8646 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8647 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8648 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8650 static void
8651 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8652 struct frame *f;
8653 int change_gravity;
8654 int cols, rows;
8656 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8658 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8659 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8660 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8662 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8663 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8664 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8666 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8668 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8669 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8671 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8672 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8674 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8675 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8676 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8678 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8679 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8680 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8681 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8683 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8684 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8685 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8686 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8687 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8689 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8690 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8691 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8692 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8693 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8695 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8696 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8697 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8698 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8699 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8701 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8705 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8706 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8707 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8708 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8710 void
8711 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8712 struct frame *f;
8713 int change_gravity;
8714 int cols, rows;
8716 BLOCK_INPUT;
8718 #ifdef USE_GTK
8719 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8720 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8721 else
8722 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8723 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8725 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8727 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8728 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8729 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8730 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8731 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8732 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8733 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8734 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8735 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8737 else
8738 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8740 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8742 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8744 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8746 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8747 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8749 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8750 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8751 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8752 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8753 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8755 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8758 /* Mouse warping. */
8760 void
8761 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8762 struct frame *f;
8763 int x, y;
8765 int pix_x, pix_y;
8767 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8768 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8770 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8771 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8773 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8774 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8776 BLOCK_INPUT;
8778 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8779 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8780 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8783 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8785 void
8786 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8787 struct frame *f;
8788 int pix_x, pix_y;
8790 BLOCK_INPUT;
8792 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8793 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8794 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8797 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8799 void
8800 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8801 struct frame *f;
8803 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8804 x_raise_frame (f);
8805 #endif
8806 #if 0
8807 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8808 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8809 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8810 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8811 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8812 #endif /* ! 0 */
8815 void
8816 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8817 struct frame *f;
8819 #if 0
8820 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8821 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8822 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8823 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8824 #endif /* ! 0 */
8827 /* Raise frame F. */
8829 void
8830 x_raise_frame (f)
8831 struct frame *f;
8833 BLOCK_INPUT;
8834 if (f->async_visible)
8835 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8837 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8838 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8841 /* Lower frame F. */
8843 void
8844 x_lower_frame (f)
8845 struct frame *f;
8847 if (f->async_visible)
8849 BLOCK_INPUT;
8850 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8851 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8852 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8856 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8858 void
8859 x_ewmh_activate_frame (f)
8860 FRAME_PTR f;
8862 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8863 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Standards_2fwm_2dspec */
8865 const char *atom = "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW";
8866 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, atom))
8868 Lisp_Object frame;
8869 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8870 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8871 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8872 make_number (32),
8873 Fcons (make_number (1),
8874 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8875 Qnil)));
8879 static void
8880 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8881 FRAME_PTR f;
8882 int raise_flag;
8884 if (raise_flag)
8885 x_raise_frame (f);
8886 else
8887 x_lower_frame (f);
8890 /* Change of visibility. */
8892 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8893 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8894 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8895 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8896 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8897 finishes with it. */
8899 void
8900 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8901 struct frame *f;
8903 Lisp_Object type;
8904 int original_top, original_left;
8905 int retry_count = 2;
8907 retry:
8909 BLOCK_INPUT;
8911 type = x_icon_type (f);
8912 if (!NILP (type))
8913 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8915 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8917 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8918 call x_set_offset a second time
8919 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8920 before the window gets really visible. */
8921 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8922 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8923 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8925 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8927 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8928 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8929 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8930 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8931 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8932 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8933 #ifdef USE_GTK
8934 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8935 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8936 #else
8937 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8938 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8939 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8940 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8941 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8942 to come back ok without this. */
8943 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8944 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8945 #endif
8948 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8950 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8951 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8952 so that incoming events are handled. */
8954 Lisp_Object frame;
8955 int count;
8956 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8957 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8958 will set it when they are handled. */
8959 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8961 original_left = f->left_pos;
8962 original_top = f->top_pos;
8964 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8965 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8967 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8969 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8970 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8971 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8972 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8974 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8975 because the window manager may choose the position
8976 and we don't want to override it. */
8978 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8979 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8980 && previously_visible)
8982 Drawable rootw;
8983 int x, y;
8984 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8986 BLOCK_INPUT;
8988 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8989 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8990 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8991 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8992 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8993 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8994 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8995 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8996 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8998 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8999 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9000 original_left, original_top);
9002 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9005 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9007 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9008 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9009 MapNotify at all.. */
9010 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9011 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9013 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9014 x_sync (f);
9016 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9017 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9018 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9019 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9020 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9021 probably a bug. */
9022 if (input_polling_used ())
9024 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9025 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9026 handler reset it. */
9027 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
9028 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9029 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9030 poll_for_input_1 ();
9031 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9034 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9035 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9038 /* 2000-09-28: In
9040 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9041 (iconify-frame f)
9042 (raise-frame f))
9044 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9045 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9046 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9047 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9049 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9050 goto retry;
9054 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9056 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9058 void
9059 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
9060 struct frame *f;
9062 Window window;
9064 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9065 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9067 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9068 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9069 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9071 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
9072 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
9073 return;
9074 #endif
9076 BLOCK_INPUT;
9078 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9079 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9080 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9081 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9082 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9083 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9085 #ifdef USE_GTK
9086 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9087 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9088 else
9089 #endif
9091 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9093 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9094 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9096 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9097 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9099 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
9101 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
9102 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9104 XEvent unmap;
9106 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
9107 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
9108 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9109 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
9110 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9111 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9112 False,
9113 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
9114 &unmap))
9116 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9117 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
9121 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
9122 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
9123 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
9126 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9127 just by the event that we get from the server.
9128 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9129 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9130 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9131 f->visible = 0;
9132 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9133 f->async_visible = 0;
9134 f->async_iconified = 0;
9136 x_sync (f);
9138 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9141 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9143 void
9144 x_iconify_frame (f)
9145 struct frame *f;
9147 int result;
9148 Lisp_Object type;
9150 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9151 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9152 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9154 if (f->async_iconified)
9155 return;
9157 BLOCK_INPUT;
9159 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9161 type = x_icon_type (f);
9162 if (!NILP (type))
9163 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9165 #ifdef USE_GTK
9166 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9168 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9169 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9171 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9172 f->iconified = 1;
9173 f->visible = 1;
9174 f->async_iconified = 1;
9175 f->async_visible = 0;
9176 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9177 return;
9179 #endif
9181 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9183 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9185 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9186 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9187 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9188 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9189 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9190 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9191 so we have to record it here. */
9192 f->iconified = 1;
9193 f->visible = 1;
9194 f->async_iconified = 1;
9195 f->async_visible = 0;
9196 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9197 return;
9200 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9201 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9202 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9203 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9205 if (!result)
9206 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9208 f->async_iconified = 1;
9209 f->async_visible = 0;
9212 BLOCK_INPUT;
9213 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9214 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9215 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9217 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9218 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9219 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
9220 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9222 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9223 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9225 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9226 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9228 XEvent message;
9230 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9231 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9232 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9233 message.xclient.format = 32;
9234 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9236 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9237 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9238 False,
9239 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9240 &message))
9242 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9243 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9247 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9248 IconicState. */
9249 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9251 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9253 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9254 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9257 f->async_iconified = 1;
9258 f->async_visible = 0;
9260 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9261 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9262 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9266 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9268 void
9269 x_free_frame_resources (f)
9270 struct frame *f;
9272 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9273 Lisp_Object bar;
9274 struct scroll_bar *b;
9276 BLOCK_INPUT;
9278 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9279 commands to the X server. */
9280 if (dpyinfo->display)
9282 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9283 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9285 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9286 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9287 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9288 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9289 toolkit scroll bars. */
9290 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9292 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9293 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9295 #endif
9297 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9298 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9299 free_frame_xic (f);
9300 #endif
9302 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9303 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9305 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9306 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9308 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9309 we are using a toolkit. */
9310 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9311 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9313 free_frame_menubar (f);
9314 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9316 #ifdef USE_GTK
9317 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
9318 frames. We must check and free both types. */
9319 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9321 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9322 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
9323 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
9325 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9327 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9328 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9329 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9331 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
9332 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
9333 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9334 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9335 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9336 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9338 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9339 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9340 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9341 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9342 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9343 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9344 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9345 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9346 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9347 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9348 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9349 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9350 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9351 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9352 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9354 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9355 free_frame_faces (f);
9357 x_free_gcs (f);
9358 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9361 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9362 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9364 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9365 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9367 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9368 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9369 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9370 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9371 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9372 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9374 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9376 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9377 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9378 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9379 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9380 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9381 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9382 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9385 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9389 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9391 void
9392 x_destroy_window (f)
9393 struct frame *f;
9395 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9397 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9398 commands to the X server. */
9399 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9400 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9402 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9406 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9408 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9409 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9410 that the window now has.
9411 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9412 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9413 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9415 #ifndef USE_GTK
9416 void
9417 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9418 struct frame *f;
9419 long flags;
9420 int user_position;
9422 XSizeHints size_hints;
9424 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9425 Arg al[2];
9426 int ac = 0;
9427 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9428 #endif
9430 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9432 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9433 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9435 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9436 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9438 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9439 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9440 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9441 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9442 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9443 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9444 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9445 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9446 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9447 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9449 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9450 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9451 size_hints.max_width
9452 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9453 size_hints.max_height
9454 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9456 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9458 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9459 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9460 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9462 int base_width, base_height;
9463 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9465 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9466 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9468 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9470 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9471 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9472 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9473 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9474 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9476 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9477 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9478 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9480 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9481 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9482 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9483 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9484 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9485 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9486 #else
9487 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9488 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9489 #endif
9492 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9493 if (flags)
9495 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9496 goto no_read;
9498 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9501 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9502 long supplied_return;
9503 int value;
9505 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9506 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9507 &supplied_return);
9508 #else
9509 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9510 #endif
9512 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9513 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9514 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9515 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9516 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9517 #endif
9519 if (flags)
9520 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9521 else
9523 if (value == 0)
9524 hints.flags = 0;
9525 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9526 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9527 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9528 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9529 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9530 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9531 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9532 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9536 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9537 no_read:
9538 #endif
9540 #ifdef PWinGravity
9541 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9542 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9544 if (user_position)
9546 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9547 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9549 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9551 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9552 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9553 #else
9554 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9555 #endif
9557 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9559 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9561 void
9562 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9563 struct frame *f;
9564 int state;
9566 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9567 Arg al[1];
9569 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9570 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9571 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9572 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9574 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9575 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9577 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9578 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9581 void
9582 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9583 struct frame *f;
9584 int pixmap_id;
9586 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9588 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9589 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9590 #endif
9592 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9594 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9595 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9596 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9597 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9599 else
9601 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9602 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9603 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9604 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9605 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9606 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9607 best to explicitly give up. */
9608 #if 0
9609 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9610 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9611 #else
9612 return;
9613 #endif
9617 #ifdef USE_GTK
9619 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9620 return;
9623 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9626 Arg al[1];
9627 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9628 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9629 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9630 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9633 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9635 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9636 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9638 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9641 void
9642 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9643 struct frame *f;
9644 int icon_x, icon_y;
9646 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9648 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9649 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9650 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9652 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9656 /***********************************************************************
9657 Fonts
9658 ***********************************************************************/
9660 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9662 struct font_info *
9663 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9664 FRAME_PTR f;
9665 int font_idx;
9667 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9671 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9673 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9674 to be listed.
9676 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9678 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9679 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9680 on how many fonts to match. */
9682 Lisp_Object
9683 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9684 struct frame *f;
9685 Lisp_Object pattern;
9686 int size;
9687 int maxnames;
9689 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9690 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9691 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9692 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9693 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9694 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9695 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9697 if (size < 0)
9699 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9700 size = 0;
9703 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9704 if (NILP (patterns))
9705 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9707 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9708 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9709 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9711 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9713 int num_fonts;
9714 char **names = NULL;
9716 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9717 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9718 The cache is an alist of the form:
9719 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9720 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9721 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9722 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9723 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9724 if (!NILP (list))
9726 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9727 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9728 goto label_cached;
9731 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9733 BLOCK_INPUT;
9734 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9736 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9738 XFontStruct *font;
9739 unsigned long value;
9741 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9742 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9744 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9745 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9746 font = NULL;
9747 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9750 if (font
9751 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9753 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9754 int len = strlen (name);
9755 char *tmp;
9757 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9758 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9759 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9760 if (len == 0)
9761 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9762 else
9764 num_fonts = 1;
9765 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9766 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9767 simple var. */
9768 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9769 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9770 XFree (name);
9773 else
9774 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9776 if (font)
9777 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9780 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9782 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9783 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9784 if (maxnames < 0)
9786 int limit;
9788 for (limit = 500;;)
9790 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9791 if (num_fonts == limit)
9793 BLOCK_INPUT;
9794 XFreeFontNames (names);
9795 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9796 limit *= 2;
9798 else
9799 break;
9802 else
9803 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9804 &num_fonts);
9806 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9808 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9809 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9810 names = NULL;
9811 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9815 x_uncatch_errors ();
9816 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9818 if (names)
9820 int i;
9822 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9823 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9824 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9826 int width = 0;
9827 char *p = names[i];
9828 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9830 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9831 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9832 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9833 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9834 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9835 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9836 while (*p)
9837 if (*p++ == '-')
9839 dashes++;
9840 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9841 width = atoi (p);
9842 else if (dashes == 9)
9843 resx = atoi (p);
9844 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9845 average_width = atoi (p);
9848 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9849 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9851 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9852 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9854 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9855 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9856 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9857 >= 0))
9858 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9859 width of this font. */
9860 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9861 else
9862 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9863 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9868 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9870 BLOCK_INPUT;
9871 XFreeFontNames (names);
9872 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9876 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9877 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9878 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9880 label_cached:
9881 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9883 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9884 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9885 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9887 int found_size;
9889 tem = XCAR (list);
9891 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9892 continue;
9893 if (!size)
9895 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9896 continue;
9899 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9901 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9902 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9903 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9905 BLOCK_INPUT;
9906 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9907 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9908 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9909 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9911 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9912 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9913 thisinfo = NULL;
9914 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9916 x_uncatch_errors ();
9917 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9919 if (thisinfo)
9921 XSETCDR (tem,
9922 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9923 ? make_number (0)
9924 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9925 BLOCK_INPUT;
9926 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9927 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9929 else
9930 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9931 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9932 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9933 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9936 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9937 if (found_size == size)
9938 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9939 else if (found_size > 0)
9941 if (NILP (second_best))
9942 second_best = tem;
9943 else if (found_size < size)
9945 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9946 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9947 second_best = tem;
9949 else
9951 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9952 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9953 second_best = tem;
9957 if (!NILP (newlist))
9958 break;
9959 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9961 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9962 break;
9966 return newlist;
9970 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9972 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9973 font table. */
9975 static void
9976 x_check_font (f, font)
9977 struct frame *f;
9978 XFontStruct *font;
9980 int i;
9981 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9983 xassert (font != NULL);
9985 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9986 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9987 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9988 break;
9990 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9993 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9995 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9996 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9997 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9998 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9999 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
10001 static INLINE void
10002 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
10003 XFontStruct *font;
10004 int *w, *h;
10006 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
10007 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
10009 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
10010 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
10011 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
10012 if (*w <= 0)
10013 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
10017 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
10018 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
10019 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
10020 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
10021 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
10023 static int
10024 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
10025 struct frame *f;
10027 int i;
10028 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10029 XFontStruct *font;
10030 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
10031 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
10033 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
10034 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
10036 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
10037 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10039 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
10040 int w, h;
10042 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
10043 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
10044 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
10046 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
10047 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
10050 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
10051 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
10053 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
10054 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
10055 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
10059 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
10060 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
10061 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
10062 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
10064 struct font_info *
10065 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
10066 struct frame *f;
10067 register char *fontname;
10068 int size;
10070 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10071 Lisp_Object font_names;
10073 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
10074 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
10075 we already have by comparing names. */
10076 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
10078 if (!NILP (font_names))
10080 Lisp_Object tail;
10081 int i;
10083 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10084 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
10085 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10086 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
10087 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
10088 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
10089 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
10090 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10093 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
10095 char *full_name;
10096 XFontStruct *font;
10097 struct font_info *fontp;
10098 unsigned long value;
10099 int i;
10101 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
10102 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
10103 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
10104 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
10105 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
10106 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
10107 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
10109 BLOCK_INPUT;
10110 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10111 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
10112 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
10114 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
10115 server. Let's just ignore it. */
10116 font = NULL;
10117 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10119 x_uncatch_errors ();
10120 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10121 if (!font)
10122 return NULL;
10124 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
10125 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
10126 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
10127 break;
10129 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
10130 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
10131 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
10133 int sz;
10134 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
10135 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
10136 dpyinfo->font_table
10137 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
10140 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
10141 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
10142 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
10144 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
10145 BLOCK_INPUT;
10146 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
10147 fontp->font = font;
10148 fontp->font_idx = i;
10149 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
10150 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
10152 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
10154 /* Fixed width font. */
10155 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
10157 else
10159 XChar2b char2b;
10160 XCharStruct *pcm;
10162 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
10163 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
10164 if (pcm)
10165 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
10166 else
10167 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
10169 fontp->average_width
10170 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
10171 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
10172 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
10173 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
10174 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
10176 if (pcm)
10178 int width = pcm->width;
10179 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
10180 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
10181 width += pcm->width;
10182 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
10184 else
10185 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
10189 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
10190 full_name = 0;
10191 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
10193 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
10194 char *p = name;
10195 int dashes = 0;
10197 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
10198 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
10199 so don't use it.
10200 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
10201 stored in them. */
10202 while (*p)
10204 if (*p == '-')
10205 dashes++;
10206 p++;
10209 if (dashes >= 13)
10211 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
10212 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
10215 XFree (name);
10218 if (full_name != 0)
10219 fontp->full_name = full_name;
10220 else
10221 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
10223 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
10224 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
10226 if (NILP (font_names))
10228 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
10229 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
10230 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
10231 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
10232 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
10233 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
10234 Qnil);
10236 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10237 Fcons (Fcons (key,
10238 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
10239 make_number (fontp->size)),
10240 Qnil)),
10241 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10242 if (full_name)
10244 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
10245 Qnil);
10246 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10247 Fcons (Fcons (key,
10248 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
10249 make_number (fontp->size)),
10250 Qnil)),
10251 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10255 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
10256 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
10257 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
10258 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
10259 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
10260 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
10261 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
10262 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
10263 fontp->encoding[1]
10264 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
10265 /* 1-byte font */
10266 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10267 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10268 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
10269 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
10270 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
10271 /* 2-byte font */
10272 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
10273 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
10274 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10275 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10276 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
10277 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
10278 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
10279 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
10280 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10281 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10282 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
10283 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
10284 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
10286 fontp->baseline_offset
10287 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
10288 ? (long) value : 0);
10289 fontp->relative_compose
10290 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
10291 ? (long) value : 0);
10292 fontp->default_ascent
10293 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
10294 ? (long) value : 0);
10296 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
10297 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
10298 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
10299 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
10300 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
10301 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
10302 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10303 return fontp;
10308 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
10309 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
10311 struct font_info *
10312 x_query_font (f, fontname)
10313 struct frame *f;
10314 register char *fontname;
10316 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10317 int i;
10319 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10320 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10321 && (!xstricmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
10322 || !xstricmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
10323 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10324 return NULL;
10328 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
10329 `encoder' of the structure. */
10331 void
10332 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
10333 struct font_info *fontp;
10335 Lisp_Object list, elt;
10337 elt = Qnil;
10338 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
10340 elt = XCAR (list);
10341 if (CONSP (elt)
10342 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
10343 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
10344 >= 0)
10345 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
10346 >= 0)))
10347 break;
10350 if (! NILP (list))
10352 struct ccl_program *ccl
10353 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
10355 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
10356 xfree (ccl);
10357 else
10358 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10364 /***********************************************************************
10365 Initialization
10366 ***********************************************************************/
10368 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10369 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10370 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10371 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10373 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10374 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10375 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10377 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10378 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10379 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10380 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10381 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10382 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10383 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10386 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
10388 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
10390 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10392 static int x_initialized;
10394 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10395 static int x_session_initialized;
10396 #endif
10398 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10399 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10400 the screen number from the server number. */
10401 static int
10402 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10403 const char *name1, *name2;
10405 int seen_colon = 0;
10406 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10407 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10408 int length_until_period = 0;
10410 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10411 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10412 length_until_period++;
10414 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10415 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10416 name1 += 4;
10417 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10418 name2 += 4;
10419 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10420 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10421 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10422 name1 += system_name_length;
10423 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10424 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10425 name2 += system_name_length;
10426 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10427 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10428 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10429 name1 += length_until_period;
10430 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10431 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10432 name2 += length_until_period;
10434 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10436 if (*name1 == ':')
10437 seen_colon++;
10438 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10439 return 1;
10441 return (seen_colon
10442 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10443 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10445 #endif
10447 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10448 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10449 to 5. */
10450 static void
10451 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10452 unsigned long mask;
10453 int *bits;
10454 int *offset;
10456 int nr = 0;
10457 int off = 0;
10459 while (!(mask & 1))
10461 off++;
10462 mask >>= 1;
10465 while (mask & 1)
10467 nr++;
10468 mask >>= 1;
10471 *offset = off;
10472 *bits = nr;
10476 x_display_ok (display)
10477 const char * display;
10479 int dpy_ok = 1;
10480 Display *dpy;
10482 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
10483 if (dpy)
10484 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
10485 else
10486 dpy_ok = 0;
10487 return dpy_ok;
10490 struct x_display_info *
10491 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10492 Lisp_Object display_name;
10493 char *xrm_option;
10494 char *resource_name;
10496 int connection;
10497 Display *dpy;
10498 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10499 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10501 BLOCK_INPUT;
10503 if (!x_initialized)
10505 x_initialize ();
10506 ++x_initialized;
10509 #ifdef USE_GTK
10511 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10512 int argc;
10513 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10514 char **argv2 = argv;
10515 GdkAtom atom;
10517 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10519 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10520 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10521 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10522 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10523 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10525 else
10527 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10528 argv[argc] = 0;
10530 argc = 0;
10531 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10533 if (! NILP (display_name))
10535 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10536 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10539 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10540 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10542 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10543 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10544 #endif
10546 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10548 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10549 fixup_locale ();
10550 xg_initialize ();
10552 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10554 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10555 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10557 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10559 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10560 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10562 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10563 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10565 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10566 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10569 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10570 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10573 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10574 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10575 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10576 errors with X11R5:
10577 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10578 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10579 So let's not use it until R6. */
10580 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10581 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10582 #endif
10585 int argc = 0;
10586 char *argv[3];
10588 argv[0] = "";
10589 argc = 1;
10590 if (xrm_option)
10592 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10593 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10595 turn_on_atimers (0);
10596 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10597 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10598 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10599 &argc, argv);
10600 turn_on_atimers (1);
10602 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10603 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10604 fixup_locale ();
10605 #endif
10608 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10609 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10610 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10611 #endif
10612 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10613 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10614 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10616 /* Detect failure. */
10617 if (dpy == 0)
10619 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10620 return 0;
10623 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10625 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10626 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10628 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10630 struct x_display_info *share;
10631 Lisp_Object tail;
10633 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10634 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10635 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10636 SDATA (display_name)))
10637 break;
10638 if (share)
10639 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10640 else
10642 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10643 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10644 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10646 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10647 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10648 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10649 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10650 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10651 BLOCK_INPUT;
10654 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10655 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10656 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10657 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10658 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10659 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10660 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10662 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10664 #endif
10666 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10667 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10668 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10670 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10671 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10672 x_display_name_list);
10673 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10675 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10677 #if 0
10678 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10679 #endif /* ! 0 */
10681 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10682 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10683 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10684 + 2);
10685 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10686 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10688 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10689 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10691 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10692 #ifdef USE_GTK
10693 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10694 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10695 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10697 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10698 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10700 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10701 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10702 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10703 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10704 #else
10705 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10706 #endif
10707 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10708 all versions. */
10709 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10711 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10712 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10713 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10714 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10715 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10716 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10717 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10718 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10719 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10720 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10721 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10722 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10723 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10724 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10725 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10726 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10727 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10728 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10729 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10730 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10731 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10732 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10733 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10734 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10735 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10736 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10737 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10738 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10739 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10740 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10741 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10742 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10743 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10745 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10746 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10747 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10749 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10751 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10752 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10753 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10754 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10755 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10756 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10759 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10760 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10762 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10764 Lisp_Object value;
10765 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10766 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10767 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10768 Qnil, Qnil);
10769 if (STRINGP (value)
10770 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10771 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10772 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10775 else
10776 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10777 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10780 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10781 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10782 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10783 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10784 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10785 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10786 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10787 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10788 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10791 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10792 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10793 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10794 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10795 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10796 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10797 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10798 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10799 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10800 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10801 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10802 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10803 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10804 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10805 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10806 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10807 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10808 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10809 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10810 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10811 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10812 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10813 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10814 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10815 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10816 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10817 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10818 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10819 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10820 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10821 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10822 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10823 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10824 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10825 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10826 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10827 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10828 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10829 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10830 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10831 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10832 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10833 /* For properties of font. */
10834 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10835 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10836 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10837 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10838 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10839 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10840 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10841 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10842 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10843 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10845 /* Ghostscript support. */
10846 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10847 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10849 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10850 False);
10852 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10854 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10855 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10856 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10857 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10859 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10860 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10861 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10863 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10864 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10867 char null_bits[1];
10869 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10871 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10872 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10873 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10878 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10879 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10880 dpyinfo->gray
10881 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10882 gray_bitmap_bits,
10883 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10884 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10887 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10888 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10889 #endif
10891 #ifdef subprocesses
10892 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10893 if (connection != 0)
10894 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10895 #endif
10897 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10898 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10899 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10900 /* stdin is a socket here */
10901 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10902 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10903 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10904 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10905 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10906 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10908 #ifdef SIGIO
10909 if (interrupt_input)
10910 init_sigio (connection);
10911 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10913 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10914 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10915 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10916 so that Xt does not crash. */
10918 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10919 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10920 Font font;
10922 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10923 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10924 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10925 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10926 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10927 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10928 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10929 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10930 abort ();
10931 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10932 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10933 x_uncatch_errors ();
10935 #endif
10936 #endif
10938 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10939 for debugging X code. */
10941 Lisp_Object value;
10942 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10943 build_string ("synchronous"),
10944 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10945 Qnil, Qnil);
10946 if (STRINGP (value)
10947 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10948 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10949 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10953 Lisp_Object value;
10954 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10955 build_string ("useXIM"),
10956 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10957 Qnil, Qnil);
10958 #ifdef USE_XIM
10959 if (STRINGP (value)
10960 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10961 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10962 use_xim = 0;
10963 #else
10964 if (STRINGP (value)
10965 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10966 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10967 use_xim = 1;
10968 #endif
10971 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10972 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10973 if (!x_session_initialized++)
10974 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10975 #endif
10977 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10979 return dpyinfo;
10982 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10983 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10985 void
10986 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10987 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10989 int i;
10991 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10993 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10994 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10995 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10996 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10997 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10998 else
11000 Lisp_Object tail;
11002 tail = x_display_name_list;
11003 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
11005 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
11007 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
11008 break;
11010 tail = XCDR (tail);
11014 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
11015 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
11017 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
11018 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
11019 else
11021 struct x_display_info *tail;
11023 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
11024 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
11025 tail->next = tail->next->next;
11028 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
11029 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
11030 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
11031 #endif
11032 #endif
11033 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
11034 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
11035 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
11036 #endif
11037 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11038 if (dpyinfo->xim)
11039 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
11040 #endif
11042 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
11043 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
11044 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
11046 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
11047 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
11048 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
11051 if (dpyinfo->font_table)
11053 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
11054 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
11055 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
11057 if (dpyinfo->x_id_name)
11058 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
11059 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
11060 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
11061 xfree (dpyinfo);
11064 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11066 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
11067 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
11068 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
11069 that slows us down. */
11071 static void
11072 x_process_timeouts (timer)
11073 struct atimer *timer;
11075 BLOCK_INPUT;
11076 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
11077 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
11079 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
11080 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
11081 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
11082 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
11084 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11087 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
11088 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
11089 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
11090 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
11091 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
11092 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
11093 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
11095 void
11096 x_activate_timeout_atimer ()
11098 BLOCK_INPUT;
11099 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
11101 EMACS_TIME interval;
11103 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
11104 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
11105 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
11107 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11110 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11113 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
11115 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
11117 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
11119 x_frame_parm_handlers,
11120 x_produce_glyphs,
11121 x_write_glyphs,
11122 x_insert_glyphs,
11123 x_clear_end_of_line,
11124 x_scroll_run,
11125 x_after_update_window_line,
11126 x_update_window_begin,
11127 x_update_window_end,
11128 x_cursor_to,
11129 x_flush,
11130 #ifdef XFlush
11131 x_flush,
11132 #else
11133 0, /* flush_display_optional */
11134 #endif
11135 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
11136 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
11137 x_fix_overlapping_area,
11138 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
11139 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
11140 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
11141 x_per_char_metric,
11142 x_encode_char,
11143 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
11144 x_draw_glyph_string,
11145 x_define_frame_cursor,
11146 x_clear_frame_area,
11147 x_draw_window_cursor,
11148 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
11149 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
11152 void
11153 x_initialize ()
11155 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
11157 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
11158 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
11159 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
11160 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
11161 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
11162 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
11163 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
11164 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
11165 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
11166 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
11167 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
11168 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
11169 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
11170 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
11171 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
11172 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
11173 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
11174 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
11175 fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
11177 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
11178 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
11179 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
11180 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
11181 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
11182 off the bottom */
11183 baud_rate = 19200;
11185 x_noop_count = 0;
11186 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
11187 any_help_event_p = 0;
11188 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
11189 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11190 x_session_initialized = 0;
11191 #endif
11193 #ifdef USE_GTK
11194 current_count = -1;
11195 #endif
11197 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
11198 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
11200 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11201 XtToolkitInitialize ();
11203 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
11205 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
11206 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
11207 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
11208 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
11209 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
11210 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
11211 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
11213 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
11214 #endif
11216 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11217 #ifndef USE_GTK
11218 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
11219 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
11220 #endif
11221 #endif
11223 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
11224 original error handler. */
11225 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
11226 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
11228 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
11229 #ifdef SIGWINCH
11230 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
11231 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
11233 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
11237 void
11238 syms_of_xterm ()
11240 x_error_message = NULL;
11242 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
11243 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
11245 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
11246 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
11248 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
11249 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
11251 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
11252 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
11253 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
11254 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
11256 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
11257 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
11259 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
11260 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
11261 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
11262 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
11263 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
11264 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
11265 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
11267 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
11268 &x_underline_at_descent_line,
11269 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
11270 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
11271 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
11272 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
11273 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
11275 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
11276 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
11277 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
11278 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
11279 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
11280 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
11281 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
11282 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
11283 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
11285 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
11286 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
11287 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
11288 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
11289 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11290 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
11291 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
11292 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
11293 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
11294 #elif USE_GTK
11295 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
11296 #else
11297 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
11298 #endif
11299 #else
11300 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
11301 #endif
11303 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
11304 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
11306 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
11307 Qalt = intern ("alt");
11308 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
11309 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
11310 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
11311 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
11312 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
11313 Qsuper = intern ("super");
11314 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
11316 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
11317 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
11318 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11319 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
11320 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
11321 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
11323 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
11324 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
11325 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11326 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
11327 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
11328 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
11330 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
11331 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
11332 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11333 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
11334 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
11335 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
11337 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
11338 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
11339 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11340 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
11341 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
11342 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
11344 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
11345 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
11346 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
11347 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
11348 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
11349 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
11352 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
11354 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
11355 (do not change this comment) */